Initial asan cleanups
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110 default definition is used.
111
112 @node Driver
113 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114 @cindex driver
115 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117 @c prevent bad page break with this line
118 You can control the compilation driver.
119
120 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133 that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136 @end defmac
137
138 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148 everywhere it occurs.
149
150 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155 @end defmac
156
157 @defmac CPP_SPEC
158 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163 @end defmac
164
165 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CC1_SPEC
172 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174 front ends.
175 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176 for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179 @end defmac
180
181 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190 @end defmac
191
192 @defmac ASM_SPEC
193 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199 @end defmac
200
201 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205 an example of this.
206
207 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208 @end defmac
209
210 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221 @end defmac
222
223 @defmac LINK_SPEC
224 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229 @end defmac
230
231 @defmac LIB_SPEC
232 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234 command given to the linker.
235
236 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238 @end defmac
239
240 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248 @end defmac
249
250 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260 @end defmac
261
262 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268 @end defmac
269
270 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284 @end defmac
285
286 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289 the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292 @end defmac
293
294 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302 @end defmac
303
304 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308 @end defmac
309
310 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324 string constant that provides the specification.
325
326 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331 these definitions.
332
333 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336 used.
337
338 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340 @smallexample
341 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345 @end smallexample
346
347 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348 @smallexample
349 #undef CPP_SPEC
350 #define CPP_SPEC \
351 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358 @end smallexample
359
360 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363 @smallexample
364 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366 @end smallexample
367 @end defmac
368
369 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373 @end defmac
374
375 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378 @end defmac
379
380 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388 @end defmac
389
390 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
391 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
392 @end deftypevr
393
394 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
395 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
396 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
397 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
398 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
399
400 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
401 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
402 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
403 @xref{Target Fragment}.
404 @end defmac
405
406 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
407 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
408 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
409 indicates an absolute file name.
410 @end defmac
411
412 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
413 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
414 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
415 when the compiler is built as a cross
416 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
417 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
418 @end defmac
419
420 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
421 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
423 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
425 is built as a cross compiler.
426 @end defmac
427
428 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
429 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
430 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
431 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
432 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
433 is built as a cross compiler.
434 @end defmac
435
436 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
437 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
438 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
439 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
440 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
441 is built as a cross compiler.
442 @end defmac
443
444 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
445 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
446 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
447 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
448 @end defmac
449
450 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
451 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
452 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
453 cross compiler.
454 @end defmac
455
456 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
457 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
458 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
459 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
460 initialize the necessary environment variables.
461 @end defmac
462
463 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
464 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
465 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
466 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
467 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
468 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
469
470 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
471 replacement.
472 @end defmac
473
474 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
475 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
476 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
477 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
478 @end defmac
479
480 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
481 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
482 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
483 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
484 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
485 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
486 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
487 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
488 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
489
490 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
491 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
492 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
493 for C++-only directories,
494 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
495 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
496 the array with a null element.
497
498 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
499 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
500 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
501 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
502
503 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
504
505 @smallexample
506 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
507 @{ \
508 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
509 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
511 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
513 @}
514 @end smallexample
515 @end defmac
516
517 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
518
519 @enumerate
520 @item
521 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
522
523 @item
524 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
525 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
526 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
527
528 @item
529 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
530
531 @item
532 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
533 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
534
535 @item
536 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
543 compiler.
544 @end enumerate
545
546 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
547
548 @enumerate
549 @item
550 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
551
552 @item
553 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
554 value based on the installed toolchain location.
555
556 @item
557 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
558 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
559
560 @item
561 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
562 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
563
564 @item
565 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
569 compiler.
570
571 @item
572 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
573 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
574
575 @item
576 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
577 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
578
579 @item
580 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
581 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
582 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
583
584 @item
585 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
586 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
587 @file{/lib/}.
588
589 @item
590 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
591 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
592 @file{/usr/lib/}.
593 @end enumerate
594
595 @node Run-time Target
596 @section Run-time Target Specification
597 @cindex run-time target specification
598 @cindex predefined macros
599 @cindex target specifications
600
601 @c prevent bad page break with this line
602 Here are run-time target specifications.
603
604 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
605 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
606 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
607 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
608 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
609 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
610 finished command line option processing your code can use those
611 results freely.
612
613 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
614 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
615 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
616 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
617
618 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
619 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
620 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
621 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
622 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
623 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
624 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
625 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
626 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
627 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
628
629 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
630 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
631 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
632 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
633 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
634 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
635 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
636 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
637 preprocessing.
638 @end defmac
639
640 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
641 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
642 and is used for the target operating system instead.
643 @end defmac
644
645 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
646 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
647 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
648 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
649 it yourself.
650 @end defmac
651
652 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
653 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
654 any target-specific headers.
655 @end deftypevar
656
657 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
658 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
659 Its default setting is 0.
660 @end deftypevr
661
662 @cindex optional hardware or system features
663 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
664
665 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
666 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
667 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
668 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
669 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
670 definition does nothing but return true.
671
672 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
673 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
674 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
675 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
676 via attributes).
677 @end deftypefn
678
679 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
680 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
681 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
682 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
683 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
684 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
685 default definition does nothing but return false.
686
687 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
688 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
689 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
690 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
691 @end deftypefn
692
693 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
694 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
695 @end deftypefn
696
697 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
698 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
699 @end deftypefn
700
701 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
702 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
703 @end deftypefn
704
705 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
706 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
707 @end deftypefn
708
709 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
710 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
711 @end deftypefn
712
713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
714 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
715 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
716 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
717 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
718 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
719 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
720 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
721 @end deftypefn
722
723 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
724 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
725 but is only used in the C
726 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
727 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
728 frontends.
729 @end defmac
730
731 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
732 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
733 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
734 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
735 options are processed once
736 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
737 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
738 options passed explicitly.
739
740 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
741 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
742 @code{optimize} attribute.
743 @end deftypevr
744
745 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
746 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
747 @end deftypefn
748
749 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
750 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
751 @end deftypefn
752
753 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
754 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
755 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
756 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
757 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
758 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
759
760 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
761 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
762 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
763 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
764 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
765 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
766 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
767
768 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
769 is 0.
770 @end defmac
771
772 @node Per-Function Data
773 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
774 @cindex per-function data
775 @cindex data structures
776
777 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
778 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
779 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
780 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
781 when another one comes along.
782
783 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
784 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
785 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
786 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
787 to their own specific data.
788
789 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
790 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
791 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
792 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
793
794 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
795 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
796 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
797 function, for level 0.
798
799 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
800 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
801 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
802 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
803 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
804 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
805 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
806 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
807 longer supported.
808
809 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
810 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
811 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
812 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
813 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
814 @end defmac
815
816 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
817 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
818 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
819 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
820 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
821 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
822
823 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
824 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
825 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
826 @end deftypevar
827
828 @node Storage Layout
829 @section Storage Layout
830 @cindex storage layout
831
832 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
833 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
834 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
835 @xref{Run-time Target}.
836
837 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
838 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
839 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
840 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
841 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
842 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
843 macro need not be a constant.
844
845 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
846 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
847 @end defmac
848
849 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
850 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
851 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
852 @end defmac
853
854 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
855 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
856 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
857 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
858 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
859 macro need not be a constant.
860 @end defmac
861
862 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
863 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
864 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
865 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
866 the order of words in memory.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
871 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
872 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
873 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
874
875 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
876 multi-word integers.
877 @end defmac
878
879 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
880 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
881 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
882 @end defmac
883
884 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
885 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
886 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
887 @end defmac
888
889 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
890 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
891 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
892 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
893 @end defmac
894
895 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
896 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
897 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
898 @end defmac
899
900 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
901 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
902 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
903 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
904 @end defmac
905
906 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
907 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
908 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
909 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
910 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
911 @end defmac
912
913 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
914 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
915 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
916 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
917 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
918 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
919 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
920
921 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
922 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
923 @end defmac
924
925 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
926 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
927 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
928 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
929 scalar type.
930
931 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
932 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
933 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
934 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
935 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
936 counterparts.
937
938 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
939 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
940 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
941 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
942 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
943 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
944
945 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
946 @end defmac
947
948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
949 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
950 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
951 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
952 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
953 pointer} types.
954
955 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
956 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
957 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
958 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
959 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
960 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
961 the signedness may be different.
962
963 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
964
965 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
966 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
967 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
968 @end deftypefn
969
970 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
971 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
972 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
973 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
974 size of an integer.
975 @end defmac
976
977 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
978 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
979 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
980 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
981 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
982 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
983 @end defmac
984
985 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
986 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
987 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
988 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
989 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
990 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
991 @end defmac
992
993 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
994 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
995 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
996 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997 @end defmac
998
999 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1000 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1001 @end defmac
1002
1003 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1004 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1005 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1006 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1007 @end defmac
1008
1009 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1010 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1011 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1012 @end defmac
1013
1014 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1015 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1016 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1017 @end defmac
1018
1019 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1020 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1021 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1022 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1023 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1024 @end defmac
1025
1026 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1027 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1028 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1029 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1030 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1031 @end defmac
1032
1033 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1034 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1035 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1036 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1037 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1038 field alignment has not been set by the
1039 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1040 @end defmac
1041
1042 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1043 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1044 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1045
1046 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1047
1048 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1049 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1050 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1051 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1052 @end defmac
1053
1054 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1055 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1056 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1057 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1058 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1059
1060 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1061 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1062 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1063 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1064 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1065 @end defmac
1066
1067 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1068 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1069 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1070 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1071 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1072
1073 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1074
1075 @findex strcpy
1076 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1077 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1078 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1079 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1080 @end defmac
1081
1082 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1083 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1084 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1085 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1086 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1087 align the object.
1088
1089 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1090
1091 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1092 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1093 constants can be done inline.
1094 @end defmac
1095
1096 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1097 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1098 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1099 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1100 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1101
1102 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1103
1104 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1105 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1106
1107 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1108 @end defmac
1109
1110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1111 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1112 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1113 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1114 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1115 the vector element type.
1116 @end deftypefn
1117
1118 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1119 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1120 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1121 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1122 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1123 align the slot.
1124
1125 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1126 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1127 be used.
1128
1129 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1130 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1131
1132 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1133 @end defmac
1134
1135 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1136 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1137 variable @var{decl}.
1138
1139 If this macro is not defined, then
1140 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1141 is used.
1142
1143 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1144 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1145
1146 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1147 @end defmac
1148
1149 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1150 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1151 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1152 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1153
1154 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1155 @end defmac
1156
1157 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1158 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1159 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1160
1161 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1162 @end defmac
1163
1164 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1165 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1166 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1167
1168 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1169 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1170 @end defmac
1171
1172 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1173 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1174 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1175 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1176 @end defmac
1177
1178 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1179 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1180 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1181
1182 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1183 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1184 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1185 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1186 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1187
1188 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1189 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1190 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1191 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1192
1193 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1194 structure.
1195
1196 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1197 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1198
1199 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1200 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1201 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1202 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1203
1204 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1205 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1206 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1207
1208 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1209 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1210 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1211
1212 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1213 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1214 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1215
1216 @smallexample
1217 struct foo1
1218 @{
1219 char x;
1220 char :0;
1221 char y;
1222 @};
1223
1224 struct foo2
1225 @{
1226 char x;
1227 int :0;
1228 char y;
1229 @};
1230
1231 main ()
1232 @{
1233 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1234 sizeof (struct foo1));
1235 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1236 sizeof (struct foo2));
1237 exit (0);
1238 @}
1239 @end smallexample
1240
1241 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1242 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1243 @end defmac
1244
1245 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1246 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1247 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1248 @end defmac
1249
1250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1251 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1252 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1253 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1254 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1255 @end deftypefn
1256
1257 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1258 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1259 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1260 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1261
1262 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1263 @end deftypefn
1264
1265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
1266 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1267 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1268
1269 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1270 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1271 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1272 retain the field's mode.
1273
1274 Normally, this is not needed.
1275 @end deftypefn
1276
1277 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1278 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1279 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1280 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1281 @var{specified}.
1282
1283 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1284 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1285 @end defmac
1286
1287 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1288 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1289 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1290 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1291 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1292 (DImode)} is assumed.
1293 @end defmac
1294
1295 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1296 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1297 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1298 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1299 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1300 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1301 having its mode specified.
1302
1303 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1304 would most commonly define this macro if the
1305 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1306 64-bit mode.
1307 @end defmac
1308
1309 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1310 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1311 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1312 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1313
1314 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1315 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1316 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1317 @end defmac
1318
1319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1320 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1321 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1322 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1323 targets.
1324 @end deftypefn
1325
1326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1327 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1328 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1329 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1330 targets.
1331 @end deftypefn
1332
1333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1334 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1335 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1336 @end deftypefn
1337
1338 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1339 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1340 mode is towards zero.
1341
1342 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1343 floating-point arithmetic.
1344
1345 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1346 @end defmac
1347
1348 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1349 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1350 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1351 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1352
1353 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1354 floating-point arithmetic.
1355
1356 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1357 @end defmac
1358
1359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1360 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1361 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1362 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1363 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1364 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1365 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1366 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1367 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1368 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1369 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1370 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1371
1372 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1373 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1374 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1375 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1376 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1377 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1378 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1379
1380 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1381 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1382 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1383 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1384 may affect its placement.
1385 @end deftypefn
1386
1387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1388 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1389 @end deftypefn
1390
1391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1392 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1393 @end deftypefn
1394
1395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1396 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1397 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1398 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1399 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1400 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1401 usage.
1402 @end deftypefn
1403
1404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1405 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1406 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1407 @end deftypefn
1408
1409 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1410 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1411 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1412 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1413 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1414 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1415 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1416 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1417 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1418 string constant.
1419
1420 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1421 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1422 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1423 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1424 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1425 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1426 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1427 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1428 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1429 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1430 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1431 spaces in your string.
1432
1433 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1434 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1435 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1436 before mangling.
1437
1438 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1439 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1440 types.
1441 @end deftypefn
1442
1443 @node Type Layout
1444 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1445
1446 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1447 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1448 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1449 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1450
1451 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1452 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1453 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1454 @end defmac
1455
1456 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1457 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1458 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1459 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1460 unit.)
1461 @end defmac
1462
1463 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1464 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1465 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1466 @end defmac
1467
1468 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1469 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1470 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1471 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1472 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1473 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1474 @end defmac
1475
1476 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1477 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1478 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1479 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1480 macro must be at least 64.
1481 @end defmac
1482
1483 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1484 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1485 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1486 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1487 @end defmac
1488
1489 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1490 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1491 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1492 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1493 @end defmac
1494
1495 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1496 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1497 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1498 @end defmac
1499
1500 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1501 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1502 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1503 words.
1504 @end defmac
1505
1506 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1507 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1508 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1509 words.
1510 @end defmac
1511
1512 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1513 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1514 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1516 @end defmac
1517
1518 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1519 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1520 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1522 @end defmac
1523
1524 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1525 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1526 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1528 @end defmac
1529
1530 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1531 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1532 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1534 @end defmac
1535
1536 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1537 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1538 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1540 @end defmac
1541
1542 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1543 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1544 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1546 @end defmac
1547
1548 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1549 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1550 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1552 @end defmac
1553
1554 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1555 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1556 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1557 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1561 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1562 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1563 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1564 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1565 @end defmac
1566
1567 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1568 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1569 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1570 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1571 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1572 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1573 otherwise it is 0.
1574 @end defmac
1575
1576 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1577 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1578 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1581 @end defmac
1582
1583 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1584 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1585 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1586 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1587 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1588 @end defmac
1589
1590 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1591 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1592 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1593 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1594 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1595 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1596 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1597 @end defmac
1598
1599 @defmac SF_SIZE
1600 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1601 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1602 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1603 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1604 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1605 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1606 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1607 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1608 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1609 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1610 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1611 @end defmac
1612
1613 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1614 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1615 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1616 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1617 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1618 @end defmac
1619
1620 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1621 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1622 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1623 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1624 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1625 is the default.
1626 @end defmac
1627
1628 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1629 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1630 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1631 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1632 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1633 @end defmac
1634
1635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1636 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1637 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1638 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1639 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1640
1641 The default is to return false.
1642 @end deftypefn
1643
1644 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1645 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1646 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1647 contents of the string.
1648
1649 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1650 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1651 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1652 of the data type names defined in the function
1653 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1654 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1655 compiler to crash on startup.
1656
1657 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1658 int"}.
1659 @end defmac
1660
1661 @defmac SIZETYPE
1662 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1663 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1664 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1665 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1666 is extracted.
1667
1668 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1669
1670 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1671 @end defmac
1672
1673 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1674 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1675 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1676 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1677 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1678
1679 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1680 @end defmac
1681
1682 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1683 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1684 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1685 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1686 information.
1687
1688 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1689 @end defmac
1690
1691 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1692 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1693 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1694 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1695 @end defmac
1696
1697 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1698 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1699 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1700 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1701 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1702 information.
1703
1704 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1705 @end defmac
1706
1707 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1708 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1709 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1710 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1711 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1712
1713 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1714 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1715 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1716 @end defmac
1717
1718 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1719 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1720 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1721 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1722 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1723
1724 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1725 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1726 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1727 int}.
1728 @end defmac
1729
1730 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1731 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1732 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1733 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1734 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1735 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1736 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1737 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1738 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1739 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1740 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1741 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1742 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1743 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1744 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1745 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1746 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1747 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1748 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1749 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1750 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1751 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1752 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1753 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1754 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1755 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1756 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1757 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1758 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1759 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1760 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1761 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1762 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1763 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1764 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1765 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1766 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1767
1768 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1769 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1770 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1771 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1772 these macros are null pointers.
1773 @end defmac
1774
1775 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1776 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1777 that looks like:
1778
1779 @smallexample
1780 struct @{
1781 union @{
1782 void (*fn)();
1783 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1784 @};
1785 ptrdiff_t delta;
1786 @};
1787 @end smallexample
1788
1789 @noindent
1790 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1791 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1792 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1793 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1794 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1795 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1796 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1797 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1798
1799 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1800 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1801 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1802 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1803 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1804 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1805 architecture, you should define this macro to
1806 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1807
1808 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1809 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1810 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1811 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1812 @end defmac
1813
1814 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1815 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1816 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1817 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1818 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1819 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1820 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1821
1822 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1823 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1824 @end defmac
1825
1826 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1827 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1828 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1829 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1830 when special alignment is necessary. */
1831 @end defmac
1832
1833 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1834 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1835 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1836 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1837 of words in each data entry.
1838 @end defmac
1839
1840 @node Registers
1841 @section Register Usage
1842 @cindex register usage
1843
1844 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1845 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1846
1847 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1848 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1849 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1850 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1851 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1852
1853 @menu
1854 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1855 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1856 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1857 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1858 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1859 @end menu
1860
1861 @node Register Basics
1862 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1863
1864 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1865 Registers have various characteristics.
1866
1867 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1868 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1869 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1870 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1871 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1872 @end defmac
1873
1874 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1875 @cindex fixed register
1876 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1877 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1878 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1879 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1880 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1881 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1882 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1883
1884 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1885 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1886 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1887
1888 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1889 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1890 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1891 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1892 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1893 @end defmac
1894
1895 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1896 @cindex call-used register
1897 @cindex call-clobbered register
1898 @cindex call-saved register
1899 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1900 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1901 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1902 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1903 function calls.
1904
1905 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1906 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1907 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1908 @end defmac
1909
1910 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1911 @cindex call-used register
1912 @cindex call-clobbered register
1913 @cindex call-saved register
1914 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1915 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1916 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1917 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1918 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1919 @end defmac
1920
1921 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1922 @cindex call-used register
1923 @cindex call-clobbered register
1924 @cindex call-saved register
1925 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1926 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1927 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1928 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1929 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1930 @end defmac
1931
1932 @findex fixed_regs
1933 @findex call_used_regs
1934 @findex global_regs
1935 @findex reg_names
1936 @findex reg_class_contents
1937 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1938 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1939 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1940 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1941 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1942 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1943 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1944 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1945 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1946 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1947 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1948 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1949 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1950 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1951 command options have been applied.
1952
1953 @cindex disabling certain registers
1954 @cindex controlling register usage
1955 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1956 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1957 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1958 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1959 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1960 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1961 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1962
1963 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1964 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1965 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1966 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1967 @end deftypefn
1968
1969 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1970 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1971 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1972 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1973 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1974 outbound register.
1975 @end defmac
1976
1977 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1978 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1979 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1980 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1981 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1982 register.
1983 @end defmac
1984
1985 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1986 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1987 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1988 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1989 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1990 gotos.
1991 @end defmac
1992
1993 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1994 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1995 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1996 @end defmac
1997
1998 @node Allocation Order
1999 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2000 @cindex order of register allocation
2001 @cindex register allocation order
2002
2003 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2004 Registers are allocated in order.
2005
2006 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2007 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2008 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2009 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2010
2011 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2012 (all else being equal).
2013
2014 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2015 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2016 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2017 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2018 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2019 @end defmac
2020
2021 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2022 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2023 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2024
2025 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2026 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2027 register; and so on.
2028
2029 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2030 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2031
2032 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2033 @end defmac
2034
2035 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2036 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2037 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2038 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2039 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2040 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2041 should be defined.
2042 @end defmac
2043
2044 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2045 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2046 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2047 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2048 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2049 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2050 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2051 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2052
2053 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2054 @end defmac
2055
2056 @node Values in Registers
2057 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2058
2059 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2060 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2061 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2062
2063 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2064 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2065 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2066 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2067 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2068 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2069
2070 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2071 definition of this macro is
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2075 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2076 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2077 @end smallexample
2078 @end defmac
2079
2080 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2081 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2082 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2083 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2084 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2085 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2086 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2087
2088 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2089 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2090 nonzero.
2091
2092 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2093 @code{subreg_get_info}
2094 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2095 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2096 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2097 registers and so not be representable.
2098 @end defmac
2099
2100 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2101 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2102 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2103 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2104 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2105 @end defmac
2106
2107 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2108 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2109 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2110 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2111 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2112 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2113 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2114 @end defmac
2115
2116 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2117 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2118 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2119 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2120 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2121
2122 @smallexample
2123 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2124 @end smallexample
2125
2126 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2127 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2128
2129 @cindex register pairs
2130 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2131 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2132 odd register numbers for such modes.
2133
2134 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2135 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2136 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2137 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2138
2139 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2140 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2141 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2142 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2143 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2144 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2145 to be tieable.
2146
2147 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2148 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2149 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2150 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2151 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2152 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2153
2154 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2155 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2156 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2157 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2158 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2159 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2160 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2161 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2162 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2163
2164 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2165 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2166 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2167 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2168 constraints for those instructions.
2169
2170 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2171 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2172 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2173 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2174 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2175 @end defmac
2176
2177 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2178 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2179 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2180
2181 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2182 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2183 handler.
2184
2185 The default is always nonzero.
2186 @end defmac
2187
2188 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2189 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2190 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2191
2192 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2193 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2194 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2195 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2196 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2197 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2198
2199 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2200 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2201 allocation.
2202 @end defmac
2203
2204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2205 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2206 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2207
2208 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2209 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2210
2211 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2212 @end deftypefn
2213
2214 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2215 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2216 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2217 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2218 @end defmac
2219
2220 @node Leaf Functions
2221 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2222
2223 @cindex leaf functions
2224 @cindex functions, leaf
2225 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2226 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2227 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2228 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2229 normally arrive.
2230
2231 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2232 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2233 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2234 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2235 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2236 functions''.
2237
2238 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2239 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2240 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2241 accomplish this.
2242
2243 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2244 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2245 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2246 function treatment.
2247
2248 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2249 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2250 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2251 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2252 in this vector.
2253
2254 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2255 the treatment of leaf functions.
2256 @end defmac
2257
2258 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2259 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2260 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2261
2262 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2263 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2264 will cause the compiler to abort.
2265
2266 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2267 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2268 this.
2269 @end defmac
2270
2271 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2272 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2273 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2274 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2275 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2276 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2277 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2278 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2279 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2280 functions which only use leaf registers.
2281 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2282 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2283 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2284 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2285 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2286
2287 @node Stack Registers
2288 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2289
2290 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2291 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2292 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2293 stack.
2294
2295 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2296 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2297 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2298 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2299 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2300 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2301 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2302
2303 @defmac STACK_REGS
2304 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2305 @end defmac
2306
2307 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2308 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2309 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2310 @end defmac
2311
2312 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2313 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2314 of the stack.
2315 @end defmac
2316
2317 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2318 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2319 the stack.
2320 @end defmac
2321
2322 @node Register Classes
2323 @section Register Classes
2324 @cindex register class definitions
2325 @cindex class definitions, register
2326
2327 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2328 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2329 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2330 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2331
2332 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2333 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2334 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2335
2336 @findex ALL_REGS
2337 @findex NO_REGS
2338 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2339 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2340 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2341 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2342
2343 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2344 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2345 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2346 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2347 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2348 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2349
2350 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2351 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2352
2353 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2354 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2355 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2356 them in operand constraints.
2357
2358 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2359 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2360 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2361 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2362 (@pxref{Costs}).
2363
2364 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2365 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2366 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2367 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2368 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2369 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2370 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2371
2372 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2373 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2374 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2375 in their union.
2376
2377 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2378 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2379 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2380 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2381 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2382
2383 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2384 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2385 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2386 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2387 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2388 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2389 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2390 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2391 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2392
2393 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2394 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2395 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2396 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2397 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2398 tells how many classes there are.
2399
2400 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2401 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2402 in many of the tables described below.
2403 @end deftp
2404
2405 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2406 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2407
2408 @smallexample
2409 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2410 @end smallexample
2411 @end defmac
2412
2413 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2414 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2415 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2416 @end defmac
2417
2418 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2419 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2420 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2421 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2422 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2423
2424 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2425 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2426 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2427 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2428 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2429 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2430 so on.
2431 @end defmac
2432
2433 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2434 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2435 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2436 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2437 register.
2438 @end defmac
2439
2440 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2441 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2442 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2443 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2444 @end defmac
2445
2446 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2447 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2448 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2449 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2450 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2451 @end defmac
2452
2453 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2454 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2455 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2456 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2457 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2458 @end defmac
2459
2460 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2461 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2462 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2463 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2464 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2465 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2466 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2467 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2468 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2469 @end defmac
2470
2471 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2472 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2473 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2474 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2475 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2476 @end defmac
2477
2478 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2479 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2480 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2481 @end defmac
2482
2483 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2484 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2485 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2486 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2487 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2488 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2489 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2490 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2491 @code{address_operand}.
2492 @end defmac
2493
2494 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2495 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2496 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2497 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2498 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2499 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2500 than other base register uses.
2501
2502 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2503 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2504 @end defmac
2505
2506 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2507 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2508 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2509 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2510 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2511 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2512 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2513 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2514 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2515 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2516 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2517 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2518 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2519 @end defmac
2520
2521 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2522 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2523 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2524 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2525 allocated such a hard register.
2526
2527 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2528 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2529 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2530 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2531 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2532 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2533 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2534 only if neither labeling works.
2535 @end defmac
2536
2537 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2538 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2539 @end deftypefn
2540
2541 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2542 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2543 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2544 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2545 another, smaller class.
2546
2547 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2548
2549 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2550 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2551 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2552 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2553 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2554
2555 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2556 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2557 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2558 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2559 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2560 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2561 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2562 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2563 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2564 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2565 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2566
2567 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2568 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2569 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2570 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2571 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2572 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2573 @end deftypefn
2574
2575 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2576 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2577 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2578 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2579 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2580 safe:
2581
2582 @smallexample
2583 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2584 @end smallexample
2585
2586 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2587 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2588 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2589 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2590 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2591
2592 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2593 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2594 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2595 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2596 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2597 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2598 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2599 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2600 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2601 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2602 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2603
2604 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2605 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2606 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2607 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2608 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2609 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2610 @end defmac
2611
2612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2613 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2614 input reloads.
2615
2616 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2617 argument.
2618
2619 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2620 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2621 @end deftypefn
2622
2623 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2624 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2625 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2626 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2627 ordinarily be used.
2628
2629 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2630 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2631
2632 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2633 smaller class.
2634
2635 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2636 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2637 @end defmac
2638
2639 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2640 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2641 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2642 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2643 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2644 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2645 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2646 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2647 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2648 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2649 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2650 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2651 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2652
2653 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2654 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2655 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2656 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2657 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2658 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2659 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2660 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2661 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2662 of the scratch register(s).
2663
2664 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2665
2666 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2667 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2668 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2669 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2670 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2671
2672 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2673 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2674 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2675 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2676 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2677 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2678
2679 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2680 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2681 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2682 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2683 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2684
2685 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2686 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2687 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2688 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2689 single-register-class
2690 @c [later: or memory]
2691 output constraint.
2692
2693 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2694 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2695 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2696 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2697
2698 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2699 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2700 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2701 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2702 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2703 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2704 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2705 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2706
2707
2708 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2709 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2710 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2711 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2712
2713 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2714 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2715 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2716
2717 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2718 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2719 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2720 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2721 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2722 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2723 @end deftypefn
2724
2725 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2726 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2727 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2728 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2729 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2730
2731 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2732 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2733 reload phase that it may
2734 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2735 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2736 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2737 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2738 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2739 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2740
2741 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2742 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2743 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2744 class required. If the
2745 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2746 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2747 macros identically.
2748
2749 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2750 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2751 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2752 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2753 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2754
2755 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2756 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2757 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2758 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2759 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2760 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2761 register.
2762
2763 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2764 register that
2765 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2766 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2767 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2768 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2769 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2770
2771 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2772 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2773 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2774 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2775
2776 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2777 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2778 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2779 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2780 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2781 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2782 general registers.
2783 @end defmac
2784
2785 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2786 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2787 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2788 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2789 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2790 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2791 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2792
2793 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2794 @end defmac
2795
2796 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2797 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2798 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2799 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2800 defined by this macro.
2801
2802 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2803 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2804 @end defmac
2805
2806 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2807 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2808 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2809 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2810 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2811 same as that of @var{mode}.
2812
2813 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2814 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2815 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2816 registers.
2817
2818 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2819 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2820 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2821 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2822 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2823 details.
2824
2825 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2826 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2827 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2828 @end defmac
2829
2830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2831 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2832 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2833 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2834
2835 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2836 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2837 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2838 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2839 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2840 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2841 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2842 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2843 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2844 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2845 allocation.
2846 @end deftypefn
2847
2848 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2849 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2850 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2851
2852 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2853 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2854 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2855 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2856 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2857
2858 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2859 in the reload pass.
2860
2861 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2862 in words.
2863 @end deftypefn
2864
2865 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2866 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2867 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2868
2869 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2870 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2871 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2872 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2873
2874 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2875 in the reload pass.
2876 @end defmac
2877
2878 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2879 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2880 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2881
2882 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2883 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2884 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2885 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2886 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2887 as below:
2888
2889 @smallexample
2890 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2891 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2892 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2893 @end smallexample
2894 @end defmac
2895
2896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2897 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2898 @end deftypefn
2899
2900 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2901 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2902 @end deftypefn
2903
2904 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2905 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2906 @end deftypefn
2907
2908 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, enum @var{machine_mode})
2909 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2910 @end deftypefn
2911
2912 @node Old Constraints
2913 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2914 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2915 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2916
2917 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2918 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2919 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2920 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2921
2922 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2923 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2924 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2925 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2926 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2927 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2928 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2929 to handle specially.
2930 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2931 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2932 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2933 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2934 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2935 @end defmac
2936
2937 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2938 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2939 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2940 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2941 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2942 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2943 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2944 @end defmac
2945
2946 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2947 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2948 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2949 different variants.
2950 @end defmac
2951
2952 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2953 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2954 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2955 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2956 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2957 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2958 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2959 @var{value}.
2960 @end defmac
2961
2962 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2963 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2964 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2965 between different variants.
2966 @end defmac
2967
2968 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2969 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2970 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2971 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2972
2973 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2974 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2975 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2976 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2977
2978 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2979 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2980 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2981 between these kinds.
2982 @end defmac
2983
2984 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2985 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2986 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2987 between different variants.
2988 @end defmac
2989
2990 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2991 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2992 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2993 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2994 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2995 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2996 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2997
2998 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2999 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3000 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
3001 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3002
3003 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3004 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3005 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3006 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3007 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3008 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3009 does not include r0 on the output.
3010 @end defmac
3011
3012 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3013 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3014 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3015 variants.
3016 @end defmac
3017
3018 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3019 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3020 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3021 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3022
3023 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3024 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3025 comprises a subset of all memory references including
3026 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3027 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3028 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3029
3030 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3031 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3032 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3033 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3034 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3035 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3036 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3037 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3038 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3039 @end defmac
3040
3041 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3042 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3043 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3044 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3045 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3046
3047 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3048 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3049 a subset of all memory addresses including
3050 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3051 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3052 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3053
3054 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3055 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3056 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3057 @end defmac
3058
3059 @node Stack and Calling
3060 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3061 @cindex calling conventions
3062
3063 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3064 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3065
3066 @menu
3067 * Frame Layout::
3068 * Exception Handling::
3069 * Stack Checking::
3070 * Frame Registers::
3071 * Elimination::
3072 * Stack Arguments::
3073 * Register Arguments::
3074 * Scalar Return::
3075 * Aggregate Return::
3076 * Caller Saves::
3077 * Function Entry::
3078 * Profiling::
3079 * Tail Calls::
3080 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3081 @end menu
3082
3083 @node Frame Layout
3084 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3085 @cindex stack frame layout
3086 @cindex frame layout
3087
3088 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3089 Here is the basic stack layout.
3090
3091 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3092 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3093 pointer to a smaller address.
3094
3095 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3096 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3097 definition used does not matter.
3098 @end defmac
3099
3100 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3101 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3102 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3103 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3104
3105 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3106 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3107 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3108 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3109 space for the next item on the stack.
3110
3111 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3112 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3113 which is often wrong.
3114 @end defmac
3115
3116 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3117 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3118 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3119 @end defmac
3120
3121 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3122 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3123 addresses on the stack.
3124 @end defmac
3125
3126 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3127 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3128
3129 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3130 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3131 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3132 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3133 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3134 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3135 @end defmac
3136
3137 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3138 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3139 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3140
3141 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3142 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3143 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3144 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3145 @end defmac
3146
3147 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3148 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3149 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3150 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3151
3152 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3153 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3154 @end defmac
3155
3156 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3157 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3158 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3159 function.
3160
3161 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3162 the first argument's address.
3163 @end defmac
3164
3165 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3166 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3167 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3168
3169 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3170 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3171 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3172 @end defmac
3173
3174 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3175 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3176 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3177 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3178 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3179 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3180 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3181 @end defmac
3182
3183 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3184 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3185 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3186 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3187 itself.
3188
3189 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3190 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3191 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3192 @end defmac
3193
3194 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3195 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3196 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3197 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3198 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3199 define this macro.
3200 @end defmac
3201
3202 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3203 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3204 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3205 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3206 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3207 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3208 @end deftypefn
3209
3210 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3211 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3212 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3213 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3214 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3215 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3216 @end defmac
3217
3218 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3219 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3220 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3221 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3222 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3223 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3224
3225 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3226 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3227 determine the return address of other frames.
3228 @end defmac
3229
3230 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3231 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3232 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3233 @end defmac
3234
3235 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3236 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3237 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3238 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3239 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3240 the stack.
3241
3242 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3243 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3244
3245 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3246 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3247 @end defmac
3248
3249 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3250 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3251 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3252 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3253 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3254
3255 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3256 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3257 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3258 over time.
3259 @end defmac
3260
3261 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3262 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3263 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3264 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3265 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3266 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3267 @end defmac
3268
3269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3270 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3271 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3272 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3273 @smallexample
3274 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3275 @end smallexample
3276 and
3277 @smallexample
3278 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3279 @end smallexample
3280 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3281 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3282 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3283 @end deftypefn
3284
3285 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3286 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3287 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3288 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3289 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3290 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3291
3292 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3293 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3294 @end defmac
3295
3296 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3297 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3298 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3299 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3300 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3301 during virtual register instantiation.
3302
3303 The default value for this macro is
3304 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3305 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3306 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3307 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3308 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3309
3310 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3311 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3312 DWARF 2.
3313 @end defmac
3314
3315 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3316 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3317 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3318 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3319 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3320
3321 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3322 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3323 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3324 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3325 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3326 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3327 should be defined.
3328 @end defmac
3329
3330 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3331 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3332 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3333 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3334 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3335 @end defmac
3336
3337 @node Exception Handling
3338 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3339 @cindex exception handling
3340
3341 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3342 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3343 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3344 @var{N} registers are usable.
3345
3346 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3347 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3348 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3349 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3350 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3351
3352 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3353 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3354 @end defmac
3355
3356 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3357 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3358 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3359 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3360 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3361
3362 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3363 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3364
3365 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3366 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3367 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3368 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3369 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3370 that provided by DWARF 2.
3371 @end defmac
3372
3373 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3374 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3375 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3376 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3377
3378 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3379 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3380 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3381 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3382 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3383 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3384 target call frame.
3385
3386 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3387 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3388 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3389
3390 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3391 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3392 @end defmac
3393
3394 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3395 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3396 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3397 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3398 using it to return to the exception handler.
3399 @end defmac
3400
3401 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3402 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3403 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3404 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3405 and so may be read-only.
3406
3407 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3408 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3409 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3410 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3411
3412 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3413 represented directly.
3414 @end defmac
3415
3416 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3417 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3418 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3419 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3420 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3421
3422 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3423 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3424 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3425 to be emitted.
3426 @end defmac
3427
3428 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3429 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3430 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3431 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3432 through signal frames.
3433
3434 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3435 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3436 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3437 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3438 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3439 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3440 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3441 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3442 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3443
3444 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3445 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3446 @end defmac
3447
3448 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3449 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3450 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3451 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3452
3453 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3454 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3455 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3456 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3457 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3458 be updated in @var{fs}.
3459 @end defmac
3460
3461 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3462 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3463 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3464 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3465 @end defmac
3466
3467 @node Stack Checking
3468 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3469
3470 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3471 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3472 three ways:
3473
3474 @enumerate
3475 @item
3476 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3477 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3478 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3479 other special processing.
3480
3481 @item
3482 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3483 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3484 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3485 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3486 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3487 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3488 approach below.
3489
3490 @item
3491 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3492 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3493 @end enumerate
3494
3495 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3496 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3497 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3498 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3499
3500 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3501 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3502 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3503 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3504 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3505 value of this macro is zero.
3506 @end defmac
3507
3508 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3509 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3510 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3511 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3512 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3513 @end defmac
3514
3515 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3516 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3517 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3518 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3519 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3520 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3521 @end defmac
3522
3523 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3524 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3525 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3526 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3527 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3528 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3529 default value of this macro is zero.
3530 @end defmac
3531
3532 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3533 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3534 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3535 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3536 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3537 most machines.
3538 @end defmac
3539
3540 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3541 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3542 in the opposite case.
3543
3544 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3545 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3546 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3547 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3548 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3549 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3550 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3551 @end defmac
3552
3553 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3554 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3555 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3556 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3557 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3558 use the default of four words.
3559 @end defmac
3560
3561 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3562 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3563 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3564 @option{-fstack-check}.
3565 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3566 normally not need to override that default.
3567 @end defmac
3568
3569 @need 2000
3570 @node Frame Registers
3571 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3572
3573 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3574 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3575
3576 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3577 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3578 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3579 the hardware determines which register this is.
3580 @end defmac
3581
3582 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3583 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3584 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3585 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3586 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3587 @end defmac
3588
3589 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3590 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3591 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3592 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3593 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3594 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3595 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3596 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3597 used for the frame pointer.
3598
3599 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3600 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3601 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3602 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3603 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3604 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3605 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3606
3607 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3608 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3609 @end defmac
3610
3611 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3612 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3613 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3614 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3615 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3616 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3617 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3618 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3619 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3620 @end defmac
3621
3622 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3623 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3624 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3625 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3626 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3627 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3628 @end defmac
3629
3630 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3631 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3632 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3633 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3634 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3635 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3636 @end defmac
3637
3638 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3639 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3640 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3641 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3642 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3643 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3644 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3645
3646 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3647 address from the stack.
3648 @end defmac
3649
3650 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3651 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3652 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3653 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3654 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3655 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3656 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3657 not be defined.
3658
3659 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3660
3661 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3662 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3663 @end defmac
3664
3665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3666 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3667 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3668 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3669 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3670 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3671
3672 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3673
3674 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3675 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3676 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3677 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3678 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3679 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3680 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3681 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3682 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3683 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3684 to refer to those items.
3685 @end deftypefn
3686
3687 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3688 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3689 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3690 DWARF2 exception handling.
3691
3692 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3693 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3694 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3695 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3696 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3697 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3698 registers that are not call-saved.
3699
3700 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3701 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3702 @end defmac
3703
3704 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3705
3706 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3707 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3708
3709 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3710 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3711 @end defmac
3712
3713 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3714
3715 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3716 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3717 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3718 column number to use instead.
3719
3720 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3721 @end defmac
3722
3723 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3724
3725 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3726 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3727 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3728 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3729 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3730
3731 @end defmac
3732
3733 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3734
3735 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3736 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3737 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3738 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3739 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3740
3741 @end defmac
3742
3743 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3744
3745 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3746 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3747 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3748 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3749
3750 @end defmac
3751
3752 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3753
3754 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3755 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3756 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3757 defined and 0 otherwise.
3758
3759 @end defmac
3760
3761 @node Elimination
3762 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3763
3764 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3765 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3766
3767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3768 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3769 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3770 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3771
3772 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3773 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3774 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3775 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3776 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3777 pointer.
3778
3779 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3780 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3781 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3782 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3783 them.
3784
3785 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3786 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3787 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3788
3789 Default return value is @code{false}.
3790 @end deftypefn
3791
3792 @findex get_frame_size
3793 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3794 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3795 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3796 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3797 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3798 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3799
3800 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3801 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3802 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3803 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3804 @end defmac
3805
3806 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3807 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3808 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3809 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3810 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3811
3812 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3813 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3814
3815 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3816 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3817 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3818 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3819 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3820
3821 In this case, you might specify:
3822 @smallexample
3823 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3824 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3825 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3826 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3827 @end smallexample
3828
3829 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3830 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3831 @end defmac
3832
3833 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3834 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3835 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3836 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3837 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3838 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3839 knows about.
3840
3841 Default return value is @code{true}.
3842 @end deftypefn
3843
3844 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3845 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3846 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3847 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3848 defined.
3849 @end defmac
3850
3851 @node Stack Arguments
3852 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3853 @cindex arguments on stack
3854 @cindex stack arguments
3855
3856 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3857 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3858 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3859
3860 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3861 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3862 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3863 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3864 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3865 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3866 @end deftypefn
3867
3868 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3869 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3870 outgoing arguments.
3871 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3872 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3873 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3874 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3875 @end defmac
3876
3877 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3878 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3879 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3880 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3881 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3882 @end defmac
3883
3884 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3885 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3886 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3887
3888 On some machines, the definition
3889
3890 @smallexample
3891 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3892 @end smallexample
3893
3894 @noindent
3895 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3896 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3897 alignment. Then the definition should be
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3901 @end smallexample
3902
3903 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3904 @end defmac
3905
3906 @findex outgoing_args_size
3907 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3908 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3909 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3910 will be computed and placed into
3911 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3912 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3913 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3914
3915 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3916 is not proper.
3917 @end defmac
3918
3919 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3920 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3921 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3922 registers.
3923
3924 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3925 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3926 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3927 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3928 of the function.
3929
3930 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3931 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3932 which.
3933 @end defmac
3934 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3935 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3936
3937 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3938 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3939 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3940 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3941 if the function called is a library function.
3942
3943 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3944 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3945 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3946 @end defmac
3947
3948 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3949 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3950 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3951 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3952 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3953
3954 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3955 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3956 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3957 stack in its natural location.
3958 @end defmac
3959
3960 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3961 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3962 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3963 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3964
3965 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3966 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3967 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3968 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3969
3970 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3971 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3972 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3973 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3974 arguments (if known).
3975
3976 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3977 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3978 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3979 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3980 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3981 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3982
3983 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3984 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3985 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3986
3987 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3988 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3989 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3990 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3991 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3992 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3993 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3994 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3995 number of arguments.
3996 @end deftypefn
3997
3998 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3999 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
4000 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
4001 when compiling a function call.
4002
4003 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4004 have been accumulated.
4005
4006 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4007 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4008 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4009 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4010 appropriate.
4011 @end defmac
4012
4013 @node Register Arguments
4014 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4015 @cindex arguments in registers
4016 @cindex registers arguments
4017
4018 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4019 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4020 the stack.
4021
4022 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4023 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4024 register and if so, which register.
4025
4026 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
4027 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4028 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4029 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4030 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4031 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4032 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4033 syntax error has previously occurred.
4034
4035 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4036 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4037 on the stack.
4038
4039 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4040 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4041 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4042 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4043 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4044 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4045 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4046 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4047 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4048 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4049 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4050 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4051 argument is also stored on the stack.
4052
4053 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4054 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4055 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4056
4057 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4058 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4059 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4060 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4061 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4062 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4063
4064 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4065 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4066 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4067 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4068 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4069 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4070 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4071 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4072 a register.
4073 @end deftypefn
4074
4075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4076 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4077 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4078 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4079 documentation.
4080 @end deftypefn
4081
4082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4083 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4084 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4085 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4086 argument.
4087
4088 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4089 which the caller passes the value, and
4090 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4091 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4092 arrive.
4093
4094 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4095 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4096 @end deftypefn
4097
4098 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4099 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4100 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4101 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4102 pushed on the stack.
4103
4104 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4105 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4106 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4107 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4108 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4109 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4110 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4111
4112 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4113 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4114 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4115 @end deftypefn
4116
4117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4118 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4119 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4120 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4121 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4122
4123 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4124 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4125 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4126 to that type.
4127 @end deftypefn
4128
4129 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4130 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4131 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4132 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4133 by the caller.
4134
4135 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4136 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4137 not be generated.
4138
4139 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4140 @end deftypefn
4141
4142 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4143 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4144 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4145 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4146 of bytes of argument so far.
4147
4148 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4149 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4150 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4151 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4152 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4153 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4154 @end defmac
4155
4156 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4157 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4158 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4159 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4160 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4161 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4162 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4163 @end defmac
4164
4165 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4166 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4167 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4168 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4169 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4170 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4171 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4172 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4173 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4174 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4175 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4176 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4177 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4178
4179 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4180 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4181 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4182 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4183 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4184 never both of them at once.
4185 @end defmac
4186
4187 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4188 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4189 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4190 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4191 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4192 0)} is used instead.
4193 @end defmac
4194
4195 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4196 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4197 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4198 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4199
4200 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4201 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4202 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4203 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4204 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4205 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4206 @end defmac
4207
4208 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4209 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4210 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4211 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4212 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4213 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4214
4215 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4216 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4217 used for arguments without any special help.
4218 @end deftypefn
4219
4220 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4221 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4222 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4223 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4224 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4225 top.
4226 @end defmac
4227
4228 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4229 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4230 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4231 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4232 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4233
4234 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4235 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4236 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4237
4238 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4239 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4240 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4241 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4242 @end defmac
4243
4244 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4245 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4246 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4247 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4248 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4249 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4250 @end defmac
4251
4252 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4253 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4254 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4255 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4256 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4257 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4258 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4259 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4260 required.
4261 @end defmac
4262
4263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4264 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4265 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4266 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4267 @end deftypefn
4268
4269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4270 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4271 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4272 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4273 value.
4274 @end deftypefn
4275
4276 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4277 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4278 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4279 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4280 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4281 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4282 stack.
4283 @end defmac
4284
4285 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4286 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4287 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4288 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4289 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4290 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4291 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4292 point register.
4293
4294 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4295 false.
4296 @end deftypefn
4297
4298 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4299 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4300 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4301 @end deftypefn
4302
4303 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4304 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4305 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4306 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4307 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4308 variable.
4309 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4310 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4311 internal type.
4312 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4313 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4314 macro to iterate through all types.
4315 @end deftypefn
4316
4317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4318 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4319 @var{fndecl}.
4320 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4321 @end deftypefn
4322
4323 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4324 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4325 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4326 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4327 @end deftypefn
4328
4329 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4330 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4331 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4332 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4333 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4334 @end deftypefn
4335
4336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4337 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4338 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4339 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4340 @end deftypefn
4341
4342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4343 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4344 @end deftypefn
4345
4346 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4347 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4348 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4349 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4350 must work.
4351
4352 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4353 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4354 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4355 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4356 @end deftypefn
4357
4358 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4359 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4360 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4361 must have move patterns for this mode.
4362 @end deftypefn
4363
4364 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4365 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4366 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4367 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4368 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4369
4370 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4371 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4372 has operations like:
4373
4374 @smallexample
4375 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4376 @end smallexample
4377
4378 where the return type is defined as:
4379
4380 @smallexample
4381 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4382 @{
4383 int8x8_t val[3];
4384 @} int8x8x3_t;
4385 @end smallexample
4386
4387 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4388 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4389 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4390 @end deftypefn
4391
4392 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4393 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4394 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4395 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4396 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4397 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4398 for any mode.
4399
4400 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4401 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4402 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4403 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4404 insn.
4405
4406 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4407 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4408 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4409 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4410 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4411 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4412 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4413 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4414 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4415
4416 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4417 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4418 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4419 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4420 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4421 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4422 @end deftypefn
4423
4424 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4425 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4426 @end deftypevr
4427
4428 @node Scalar Return
4429 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4430 @cindex return values in registers
4431 @cindex values, returned by functions
4432 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4433
4434 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4435 values---values that can fit in registers.
4436
4437 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4438
4439 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4440 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4441 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4442 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4443 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4444 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4445 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4446 a function returns a value.
4447
4448 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4449 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4450 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4451 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4452 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4453 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4454 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4455 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4456 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4457 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4458 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4459 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4460
4461 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4462 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4463 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4464
4465 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4466 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4467 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4468 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4469 known.
4470
4471 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4472 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4473 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4474 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4475
4476 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4477 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4478 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4479 @end deftypefn
4480
4481 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4482 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4483 a new target instead.
4484 @end defmac
4485
4486 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4487 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4488 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4489
4490 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4491 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4492 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4493 compiled.
4494 @end defmac
4495
4496 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4497 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4498 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4499
4500 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4501 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4502 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4503
4504 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4505 @end deftypefn
4506
4507 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4508 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4509 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4510
4511 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4512 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4513 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4514 suffices:
4515
4516 @smallexample
4517 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4518 @end smallexample
4519
4520 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4521 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4522 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4523
4524 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4525 for a new target instead.
4526 @end defmac
4527
4528 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4529 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4530 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4531
4532 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4533 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4534 recognized by this target hook.
4535
4536 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4537 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4538 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4539
4540 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4541 @end deftypefn
4542
4543 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4544 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4545 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4546 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4547 @end defmac
4548
4549 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4550 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4551 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4552 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4553 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4554
4555 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4556 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4557 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4558 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4559 @code{SImode} rtx.
4560 @end deftypefn
4561
4562 @node Aggregate Return
4563 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4564 @cindex aggregates as return values
4565 @cindex large return values
4566 @cindex returning aggregate values
4567 @cindex structure value address
4568
4569 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4570 cases), the value is not returned according to
4571 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4572 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4573 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4574 address}.
4575
4576 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4577 memory.
4578
4579 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4580 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4581 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4582 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4583 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4584 libcalls.
4585
4586 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4587 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4588 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4589 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4590 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4591 values, and 0 otherwise.
4592
4593 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4594 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4595 to indicate this.
4596 @end deftypefn
4597
4598 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4599 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4600 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4601 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4602 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4603 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4604 target hook.
4605
4606 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4607 @end defmac
4608
4609 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4610 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4611 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4612 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4613 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4614 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4615 argument.
4616
4617 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4618 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4619 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4620 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4621 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4622 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4623 the caller.
4624
4625 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4626 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4627 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4628 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4629 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4630 @end deftypefn
4631
4632 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4633 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4634 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4635 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4636
4637 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4638 pass an address to the subroutine.
4639
4640 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4641 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4642 @end defmac
4643
4644 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4645 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4646 @end deftypefn
4647
4648 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4649 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4650 @end deftypefn
4651
4652 @node Caller Saves
4653 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4654
4655 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4656 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4657 must live across calls.
4658
4659 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4660 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4661 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4662 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4663 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4664
4665 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4666 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4667 @end defmac
4668
4669 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4670 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4671 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4672 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4673 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4674 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4675 @end defmac
4676
4677 @node Function Entry
4678 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4679 @cindex function entry and exit
4680 @cindex prologue
4681 @cindex epilogue
4682
4683 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4684 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4685
4686 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4687 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4688 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4689 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4690 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4691 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4692 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4693
4694 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4695 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4696
4697 @findex regs_ever_live
4698 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4699 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4700 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4701 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4702 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4703 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4704
4705 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4706 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4707 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4708 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4709 registers are used in the function.
4710
4711 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4712 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4713 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4714 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4715 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4716 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4717 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4718
4719 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4720 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4721 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4722 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4723 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4724 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4725 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4726 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4727 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4728 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4729 @end deftypefn
4730
4731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4732 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4733 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4734 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4735 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4736 @end deftypefn
4737
4738 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4739 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4740 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4741 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4742 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4743 @end deftypefn
4744
4745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4746 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4747 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4748 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4749 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4750 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4751 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4752 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4753
4754 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4755 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4756 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4757 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4758
4759 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4760 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4761 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4762 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4763 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4764 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4765
4766 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4767 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4768 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4769 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4770 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4771 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4772
4773 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4774 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4775 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4776 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4777
4778 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4779 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4780 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4781 number of arguments.
4782
4783 @findex pops_args
4784 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4785 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4786 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4787 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4788 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4789 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4790 @end deftypefn
4791
4792 @itemize @bullet
4793 @item
4794 @findex pretend_args_size
4795 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4796 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4797 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4798 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4799 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4800 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4801 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4802 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4803 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4804 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4805
4806 @item
4807 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4808 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4809 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4810 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4811 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4812 a save area.
4813
4814 @item
4815 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4816 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4817 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4818 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4819
4820 @item
4821 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4822 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4823 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4824 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4825 @end itemize
4826
4827 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4828 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4829 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4830 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4831 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4832 default is 0.
4833
4834 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4835 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4836 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4837 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4838 @end defmac
4839
4840 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4841 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4842 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4843 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4844 @end defmac
4845
4846 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4847 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4848 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4849 on entry to an exception edge.
4850 @end defmac
4851
4852 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4853 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4854 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4855 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4856 representing the number of delay slots there.
4857 @end defmac
4858
4859 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4860 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4861 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4862
4863 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4864 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4865 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4866 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4867 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4868 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4869 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4870 slot.
4871
4872 @findex epilogue_delay_list
4873 @findex crtl->epilogue_delay_list
4874 @findex final_scan_insn
4875 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4876 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in
4877 @code{crtl->epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4878 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4879 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4880 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4881 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4882
4883 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4884 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4885 @end defmac
4886
4887 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4888 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4889 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4890 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4891 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4892 the real function.
4893
4894 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4895 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4896 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4897 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4898 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4899 all other incoming arguments.
4900
4901 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4902 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4903 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4904
4905 @smallexample
4906 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4907 @end smallexample
4908
4909 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4910 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4911 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4912 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4913
4914 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4915 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4916 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4917 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4918
4919 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4920 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4921 some targets, but probably not.
4922
4923 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4924 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4925 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4926 not support varargs.
4927 @end deftypefn
4928
4929 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4930 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4931 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4932 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4933 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4934 previously exposed.
4935 @end deftypefn
4936
4937 @node Profiling
4938 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4939 @cindex profiling, code generation
4940
4941 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4942
4943 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4944 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4945 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4946
4947 @findex mcount
4948 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4949 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4950 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4951 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4952
4953 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4954 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4955 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4956 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4957 @end defmac
4958
4959 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4960 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4961 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4962 not support profiling.
4963 @end defmac
4964
4965 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4966 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4967 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4968 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4969 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4970 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4971 @end defmac
4972
4973 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4974 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4975 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4976 @end defmac
4977
4978 @node Tail Calls
4979 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4980 @cindex tail calls
4981
4982 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4983 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4984 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4985 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4986
4987 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4988 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4989 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4990 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4991 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4992 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4993 @end deftypefn
4994
4995 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4996 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4997 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4998 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4999 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
5000 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
5001 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
5002 @end deftypefn
5003
5004 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
5005 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
5006 @end deftypefn
5007
5008 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
5009 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
5010 @end deftypefn
5011
5012 @node Stack Smashing Protection
5013 @subsection Stack smashing protection
5014 @cindex stack smashing protection
5015
5016 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
5017 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
5018 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
5019 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
5020 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
5021 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5022
5023 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5024 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5025 @end deftypefn
5026
5027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5028 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
5029 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5030 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5031
5032 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5033 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5034 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5035 @end deftypefn
5036
5037 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5038 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5039 @end deftypefn
5040
5041 @node Varargs
5042 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5043 @cindex varargs implementation
5044
5045 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5046 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5047 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5048 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5049 conditionals to include it.
5050
5051 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5052 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5053 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5054 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5055 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5056 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5057
5058 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5059 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5060 below.
5061
5062 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5063 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5064 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5065 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5066 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5067
5068 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5069 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5070 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5071 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5072
5073 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5074 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5075 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5076 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5077 to use them for its own purposes.
5078 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5079 @c 10feb93
5080 @end defmac
5081
5082 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5083 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5084 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5085 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5086 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5087 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5088 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5089 of the current function.
5090 @end defmac
5091
5092 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5093 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5094 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5095 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5096 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5097 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5098
5099 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5100 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5101 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5102
5103 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5104 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5105 @end defmac
5106
5107 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5108
5109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5110 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5111 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5112 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5113 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5114 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5115 @end deftypefn
5116
5117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5118 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5119 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5120 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5121 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5122 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5123 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5124 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5125
5126 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5127 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5128 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5129 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5130
5131 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5132 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5133 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5134 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5135 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5136 frame.
5137
5138 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5139 compile time without knowing their data types,
5140 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5141 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5142 for all data types.
5143
5144 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5145 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5146 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5147 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5148 not generate any instructions in this case.
5149 @end deftypefn
5150
5151 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5152 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5153 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5154
5155 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5156 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5157 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5158 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5159 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5160 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5161 except the last are treated as named.
5162
5163 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5164 @end deftypefn
5165
5166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5167 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5168 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5169 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5170 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5171 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5172 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5173 @end deftypefn
5174
5175 @node Trampolines
5176 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5177 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5178 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5179
5180 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5181 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5182 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5183 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5184 trampoline.
5185
5186 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5187 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5188 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5189 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5190 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5191 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5192 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5193 operands.
5194
5195 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5196 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5197 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5198 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5199 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5200 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5201 separately.
5202
5203 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5204 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5205 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5206 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5207 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5208
5209 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5210 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5211 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5212 to generate it on the spot.
5213 @end deftypefn
5214
5215 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5216 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5217 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5218 @end defmac
5219
5220 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5221 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5222 @end defmac
5223
5224 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5225 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5226
5227 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5228 is used for aligning trampolines.
5229 @end defmac
5230
5231 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5232 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5233 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5234 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5235 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5236 when it is called.
5237
5238 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5239 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5240 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5241 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5242 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5243 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5244
5245 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5246 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5247 initializing the trampoline proper.
5248 @end deftypefn
5249
5250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5251 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5252 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5253 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5254 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5255 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5256 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5257 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5258 @end deftypefn
5259
5260 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5261 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5262 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5263 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5264
5265 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5266 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5267 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5268 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5269 latter makes initialization faster.
5270
5271 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5272 the following macro.
5273
5274 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5275 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5276 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5277 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5278 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5279 @end defmac
5280
5281 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5282 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5283 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5284 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5285 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5286
5287 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5288 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5289 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5290 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5291 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5292
5293 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5294 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5295 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5296 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5297 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5298 special assembler code.
5299 @end defmac
5300
5301 @node Library Calls
5302 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5303 @cindex library subroutine names
5304 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5305
5306 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5307 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5308
5309 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5310 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5311 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5312 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5313 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5314 @end defmac
5315
5316 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5317 @findex init_one_libfunc
5318 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5319 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5320 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5321 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5322 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5323 library routines.
5324
5325 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5326 @end deftypefn
5327
5328 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5329 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5330 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5331 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5332 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5333 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5334 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5335 @end deftypevr
5336
5337 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5338 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5339 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5340 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5341 return a tristate.
5342
5343 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5344 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5345 don't need to define this macro.
5346 @end defmac
5347
5348 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5349 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5350 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5351 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5352 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5353 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5354 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5355 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5356 @end defmac
5357
5358 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5359 @findex matherr
5360 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5361 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5362 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5363 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5364 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5365 system.
5366
5367 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5368 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5369 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5370 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5371 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5372 @end defmac
5373
5374 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5375 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5376 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5377 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5378 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5379 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5380 @end defmac
5381
5382 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5383 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5384 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5385 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5386 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5387 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5388 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5389 @end defmac
5390
5391 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5392 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5393 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5394 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5395 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5396 @smallexample
5397 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5398 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5399 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5400 @end smallexample
5401 @end defmac
5402
5403 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5404 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5405 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5406 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5407 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5408 the NeXT runtime installed.
5409
5410 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5411 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5412 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5413
5414 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5415 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5416 @end defmac
5417
5418 @node Addressing Modes
5419 @section Addressing Modes
5420 @cindex addressing modes
5421
5422 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5423 This is about addressing modes.
5424
5425 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5426 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5427 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5428 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5429 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5430 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5431 @end defmac
5432
5433 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5434 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5435 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5436 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5437 the size of the memory operand.
5438 @end defmac
5439
5440 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5441 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5442 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5443 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5444 @end defmac
5445
5446 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5447 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5448 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5449 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5450 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5451 constant addresses are supported.
5452 @end defmac
5453
5454 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5455 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5456 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5457 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5458 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5459 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5460 @end defmac
5461
5462 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5463 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5464 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5465 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5466 accept.
5467 @end defmac
5468
5469 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5470 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5471 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5472
5473 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5474 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5475 desired by the caller.
5476
5477 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5478 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5479 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5480 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5481 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5482 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5483 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5484 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5485
5486 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5487 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5488 register is required.
5489
5490 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5491 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5492 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5493 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5494 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5495
5496 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5497 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5498 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5499 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5500 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5501
5502 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5503 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5504 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5505 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5506 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5507 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5508 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5509 Format}.
5510
5511 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5512 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5513 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5514 has this syntax:
5515
5516 @example
5517 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5518 @end example
5519
5520 @noindent
5521 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5522 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5523
5524 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5525 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5526 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5527 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5528 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5529
5530 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5531 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5532 @end deftypefn
5533
5534 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5535 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5536 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5537 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5538 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5539 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5540 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5541 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5542 @code{'m'} constraint.
5543 @end defmac
5544
5545 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5546 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5547 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5548 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5549 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5550
5551 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5552 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5553
5554 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5555 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5556 @end defmac
5557
5558 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5559 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5560 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5561 address.
5562
5563 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5564 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5565 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5566 @var{x}.
5567
5568 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5569 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5570 should return the new @var{x}.
5571
5572 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5573 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5574 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5575 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5576 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5577 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5578 strategy can generate better code.
5579 @end deftypefn
5580
5581 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5582 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5583 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5584 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5585 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5586 performance reasons.
5587
5588 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5589 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5590 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5591 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5592 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5593 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5594 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5595 be shared.
5596
5597 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5598 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5599 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5600 of reload internals.
5601
5602 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5603 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5604 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5605
5606 @findex push_reload
5607 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5608 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5609 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5610
5611 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5612 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5613 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5614 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5615 @code{push_reload}.
5616
5617 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5618 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5619 the address has become legitimate.
5620
5621 @findex copy_rtx
5622 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5623 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5624 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5625 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5626 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5627 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5628 @end defmac
5629
5630 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5631 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5632 space @var{addrspace} can have
5633 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5634 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5635 but not others.
5636
5637 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5638 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5639 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5640 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5641
5642 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5643
5644 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5645 @end deftypefn
5646
5647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5648 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5649 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5650 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5651
5652 The default definition returns true.
5653 @end deftypefn
5654
5655 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5656 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5657 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5658 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5659 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5660 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5661 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5662 into their original form.
5663 @end deftypefn
5664
5665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5666 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5667 debug sections.
5668 @end deftypefn
5669
5670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5671 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5672 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5673 of @var{x}.
5674
5675 The default version of this hook returns false.
5676
5677 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5678 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5679 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5680 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5681 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5682 @end deftypefn
5683
5684 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5685 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5686 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5687 of @var{x}.
5688
5689 The default version returns false for all constants.
5690 @end deftypefn
5691
5692 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5693 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5694 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5695 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5696 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5697 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5698 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5699 function are valid.
5700 @end deftypefn
5701
5702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5703 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5704 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5705 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5706 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5707
5708 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5709 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5710 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5711 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5712 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5713 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5714 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5715 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5716 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5717 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5718 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5719
5720 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5721 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5722 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5723 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5724 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5725 described above.
5726 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5727 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5728 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5729 @end deftypefn
5730
5731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5732 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5733 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5734 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5735 @end deftypefn
5736
5737 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5738 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5739 @end deftypefn
5740
5741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5742 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5743 @end deftypefn
5744
5745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5746 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5747 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5748 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5749 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5750 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5751
5752 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5753 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5754 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5755 @end deftypefn
5756
5757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5758 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5759 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5760 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5761 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5762 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5763 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5764 @end deftypefn
5765
5766 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5767 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5768 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5769 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5770 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5771 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5772 @end deftypefn
5773
5774 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5775 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5776 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5777 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5778 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5779 @end deftypefn
5780
5781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5782 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5783 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5784 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5785 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5786 @end deftypefn
5787
5788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5789 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5790 @end deftypefn
5791
5792 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5793 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5794 @end deftypefn
5795
5796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5797 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5798 @end deftypefn
5799
5800 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5801 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5802 @end deftypefn
5803
5804 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5805 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5806 @end deftypefn
5807
5808 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5809 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5810 @end deftypefn
5811
5812 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5813 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5814 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5815 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5816 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5817 loads.
5818 @end deftypefn
5819
5820 @node Anchored Addresses
5821 @section Anchored Addresses
5822 @cindex anchored addresses
5823 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5824
5825 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5826 For example, if we have:
5827
5828 @smallexample
5829 static int a, b, c;
5830 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5831 @end smallexample
5832
5833 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5834 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5835 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5836 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5837 be something like:
5838
5839 @smallexample
5840 int foo (void)
5841 @{
5842 register int *xr = &x;
5843 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5844 @}
5845 @end smallexample
5846
5847 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5848 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5849
5850 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5851 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5852 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5853 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5854
5855 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5856 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5857 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5858 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5859 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5860 @end deftypevr
5861
5862 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5863 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5864 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5865 value is 0.
5866 @end deftypevr
5867
5868 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5869 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5870 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5871 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5872 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5873
5874 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5875 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5876 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5877 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5878 @end deftypefn
5879
5880 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5881 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5882 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5883 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5884
5885 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5886 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5887 or target-specific sections.
5888 @end deftypefn
5889
5890 @node Condition Code
5891 @section Condition Code Status
5892 @cindex condition code status
5893
5894 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5895 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5896
5897 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5898 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5899 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5900 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5901 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5902 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5903 most RISC machines.
5904
5905 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5906 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5907 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5908 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5909 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5910 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5911 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5912 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5913
5914 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5915 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5916 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5917 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5918 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5919 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5920 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5921
5922 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5923 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5924 interested in most macros in this section.
5925
5926 @menu
5927 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5928 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5929 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5930 @end menu
5931
5932 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5933 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5934 @findex cc0
5935
5936 @findex cc_status
5937 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5938 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5939 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5940 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5941 currently based, and several standard flags.
5942
5943 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5944 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5945 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5946
5947 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5948 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5949 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5950
5951 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5952 @end defmac
5953
5954 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5955 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5956 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5957 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5958 define this macro to initialize it.
5959
5960 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5961 @end defmac
5962
5963 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5964 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5965 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5966 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5967 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5968 set @code{(cc0)}.
5969
5970 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5971
5972 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5973 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5974 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5975 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5976 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5977 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5978 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5979 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5980 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5981 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5982 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5983 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5984 condition code value.
5985
5986 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5987 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5988 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5989 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5990 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5991 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5992 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5993
5994 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5995 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5996 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5997 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5998 @end defmac
5999
6000 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6001 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6002 @findex CCmode
6003 @findex MODE_CC
6004
6005 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6006 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6007 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6008 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6009 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6010 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6011 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6012 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6013 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6014 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6015 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6016
6017 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6018 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6019 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6020 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6021 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6022 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6023 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6024
6025 @smallexample
6026 (define_insn ""
6027 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6028 (compare:CC_NOOV
6029 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6030 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6031 (const_int 0)))]
6032 ""
6033 "@dots{}")
6034 @end smallexample
6035
6036 @noindent
6037 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6038 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6039
6040 @smallexample
6041 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6042 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6043 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6044 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6045 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6046 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6047 @end smallexample
6048
6049 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6050 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6051 this section.
6052
6053 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6054 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6055 @end defmac
6056
6057 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6058 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6059 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6060 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6061 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6062
6063 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6064 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6065 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6066 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6067 @var{op1} as required.
6068
6069 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6070 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6071 @file{md} file.
6072
6073 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6074 code or operands.
6075 @end defmac
6076
6077 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6078 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6079 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6080 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6081 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6082
6083 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6084 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6085 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6086 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6087
6088 @smallexample
6089 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6090 @end smallexample
6091 @end defmac
6092
6093 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6094 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6095 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6096 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6097 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6098 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6099 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6100 like:
6101
6102 @smallexample
6103 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6104 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6105 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6106 @end smallexample
6107 @end defmac
6108
6109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6110 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6111 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6112 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6113 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6114 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6115 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6116 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6117 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6118 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6119 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6120
6121 The default version of this hook returns false.
6122 @end deftypefn
6123
6124 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6125 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6126 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6127 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6128 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6129 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6130 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6131
6132 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6133 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6134 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6135 @end deftypefn
6136
6137 @node Cond Exec Macros
6138 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6139 @findex conditional execution
6140 @findex predication
6141
6142 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6143 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6144 represent conditional branches.
6145
6146 @node Costs
6147 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6148 @cindex costs of instructions
6149 @cindex relative costs
6150 @cindex speed of instructions
6151
6152 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6153 on the target machine.
6154
6155 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6156 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6157 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6158 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6159 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6160 that.
6161
6162 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6163 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6164 registers if they are not general registers.
6165
6166 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6167 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6168 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6169 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6170 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6171 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6172
6173 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6174 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6175 @end defmac
6176
6177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6178 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6179 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6180 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6181 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6182 that.
6183
6184 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6185 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6186 registers if they are not general registers.
6187
6188 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6189 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6190 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6191 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6192 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6193 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6194
6195 The default version of this function returns 2.
6196 @end deftypefn
6197
6198 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6199 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6200 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6201 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6202 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6203 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6204 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6205
6206 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6207 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6208 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6209 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6210 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6211 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6212
6213 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6214 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6215 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6216 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6217 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6218 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6219 are the same as to this macro.
6220
6221 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6222 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6223 @end defmac
6224
6225 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6226 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6227 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6228 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6229 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6230 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6231 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6232
6233 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6234 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6235 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6236 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6237 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6238 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6239
6240 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6241 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6242 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6243 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6244 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6245 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6246 are the same as to this target hook.
6247 @end deftypefn
6248
6249 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6250 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6251 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6252 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6253 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6254 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6255 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6256 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6257 @end defmac
6258
6259 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6260 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6261 ordinarily expect.
6262
6263 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6264 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6265 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6266 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6267 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6268 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6269
6270 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6271 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6272 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6273 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6274 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6275 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6276 @end defmac
6277
6278 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6279 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6280 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6281 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6282 handler.
6283
6284 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6285 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6286 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6287 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6288 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6289
6290 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6291 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6292 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6293 @end defmac
6294
6295 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6296 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6297 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6298 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6299 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6300
6301 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6302 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6303 the number of such sequences.
6304
6305 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6306 optimized for speed rather than size.
6307
6308 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6309 @end defmac
6310
6311 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6312 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6313 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6314 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6315 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6316 @end defmac
6317
6318 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6319 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6320 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6321 @end defmac
6322
6323 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6324 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6325 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6326 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6327 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6328
6329 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6330 optimized for speed rather than size.
6331
6332 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6333 @end defmac
6334
6335 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6336 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6337 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6338 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6339 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6340 @end defmac
6341
6342 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6343 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6344 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6345 a block set insn or a library call.
6346 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6347 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6348
6349 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6350 optimized for speed rather than size.
6351
6352 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6353 @end defmac
6354
6355 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6356 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6357 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6358 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6359 storing values other than constant zero.
6360 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6361 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6362 @end defmac
6363
6364 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6365 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6366 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6367 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6368 called with a constant source string.
6369 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6370 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6371 @end defmac
6372
6373 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6374 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6375 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6376 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6377 @end defmac
6378
6379 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6380 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6381 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6382 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6383 @end defmac
6384
6385 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6386 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6387 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6388 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6389 @end defmac
6390
6391 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6392 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6393 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6394 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6395 @end defmac
6396
6397 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6398 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6399 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6400 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6401 @end defmac
6402
6403 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6404 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6405 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6406 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6407 @end defmac
6408
6409 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6410 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6411 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6412 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6413 @end defmac
6414
6415 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6416 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6417 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6418 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6419 @end defmac
6420
6421 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6422 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6423 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6424 @end defmac
6425
6426 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6427 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6428 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6429 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6430 @end defmac
6431
6432 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6433 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6434
6435 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6436 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6437 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6438 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6439 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6440 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6441 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6442
6443 @var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6444 obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6445
6446 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6447 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6448 instructions.
6449
6450 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6451 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6452 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6453 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6454 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6455
6456 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6457 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6458 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6459
6460 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6461 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6462 @end deftypefn
6463
6464 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6465 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6466 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6467 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6468
6469 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6470 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6471 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6472 all addresses will have equal costs.
6473
6474 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6475 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6476 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6477
6478 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6479 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6480 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6481 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6482 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6483 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6484 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6485 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6486
6487 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6488
6489 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6490 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6491 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6492 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6493 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6494 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6495 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6496 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6497 @end deftypefn
6498
6499 @node Scheduling
6500 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6501
6502 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6503 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6504 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6505 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6506
6507 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6508 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6509 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6510 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6511 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6512 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6513 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6514 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6515 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6516 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6517 @end deftypefn
6518
6519 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6520 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6521 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6522 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6523 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6524 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6525 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6526 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6527 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6528 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6529 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6530 was scheduled.
6531 @end deftypefn
6532
6533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6534 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6535 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6536 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6537 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6538 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6539 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6540 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6541 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6542 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6543 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6544 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6545 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6546 @end deftypefn
6547
6548 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6549 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6550 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6551 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6552 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6553 scheduling priorities of insns.
6554 @end deftypefn
6555
6556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6557 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6558 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6559 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6560 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6561 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6562 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6563 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6564 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6565 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6566 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6567 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6568 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6569 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6570 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6571 @end deftypefn
6572
6573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6574 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6575 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6576 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6577 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6578 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6579 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6580 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6581 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6582 @end deftypefn
6583
6584 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6585 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6586 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6587 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6588 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6589 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6590 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6591 calculated.
6592 @end deftypefn
6593
6594 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6595 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6596 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6597 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6598 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6599 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6600 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6601 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6602 @end deftypefn
6603
6604 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6605 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6606 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6607 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6608 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6609 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6610 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6611 @end deftypefn
6612
6613 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6614 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6615 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6616 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6617 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6618 @end deftypefn
6619
6620 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6621 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6622 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6623 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6624 @end deftypefn
6625
6626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6627 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6628 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6629 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6630 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6631 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6632 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6633 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6634 @end deftypefn
6635
6636 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6637 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6638 @end deftypefn
6639
6640 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6641 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6642 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6643 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6644 @end deftypefn
6645
6646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6647 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6648 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6649 @end deftypefn
6650
6651 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6652 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6653 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6654 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6655 state on a single insn is not enough.
6656 @end deftypefn
6657
6658 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6659 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6660 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6661 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6662 state on a single insn is not enough.
6663 @end deftypefn
6664
6665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6666 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6667 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6668 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6669 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6670 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6671 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6672 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6673 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6674 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6675 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6676
6677 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6678 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6679 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6680 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6681 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6682 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6683 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6684 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6685 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6686
6687 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6688 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6689 schedules to choose the best one.
6690
6691 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6692 @end deftypefn
6693
6694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6695
6696 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6697 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6698 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6699 be issued.
6700
6701 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6702 @end deftypefn
6703
6704 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6705 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6706 scheduling.
6707 @end deftypefn
6708
6709 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6710 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6711 @end deftypefn
6712
6713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6714 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6715 an instruction.
6716 @end deftypefn
6717
6718 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6719 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6720 round of multipass scheduling.
6721 @end deftypefn
6722
6723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6724 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6725 @end deftypefn
6726
6727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6728 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6729 @end deftypefn
6730
6731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6732 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6733 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6734 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6735 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6736 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6737 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6738 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6739 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6740 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6741 and the current processor cycle.
6742 @end deftypefn
6743
6744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6745 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6746 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6747 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6748 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6749 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6750 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6751 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6752 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6753 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6754 and @code{false} otherwise.
6755
6756 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6757 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6758 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6759 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6760 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6761 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6762 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6763 @end deftypefn
6764
6765 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6766 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6767 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6768 per instruction data structures.
6769 @end deftypefn
6770
6771 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6772 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6773 @end deftypefn
6774
6775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6776 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6777 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6778 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6779 @end deftypefn
6780
6781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6782 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6783 @end deftypefn
6784
6785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6786 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6787 @end deftypefn
6788
6789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6790 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6791 @end deftypefn
6792
6793 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6794 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6795 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6796 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6797 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6798 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6799 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6800 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6801 the generated speculative pattern.
6802 @end deftypefn
6803
6804 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6805 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6806 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6807 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6808 @end deftypefn
6809
6810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6811 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6812 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6813 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6814 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6815 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6816 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6817 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6818 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6819 @end deftypefn
6820
6821 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6822 This hook is used as a workaround for
6823 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6824 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6825 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6826 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6827 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6828 For non-speculative instructions,
6829 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6830 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6831 is nearly full.
6832 @end deftypefn
6833
6834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6835 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6836 enabled/used.
6837 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6838 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6839 @end deftypefn
6840
6841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6842 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6843 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6844 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6845 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6846 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6847 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6848 @end deftypefn
6849
6850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6851 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6852 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6853 @end deftypefn
6854
6855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6856 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6857 in its second parameter.
6858 @end deftypefn
6859
6860 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6861 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6862 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6863 also the latencies of operations.
6864 @end deftypevr
6865
6866 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6867 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6868 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6869 @end deftypefn
6870
6871 @node Sections
6872 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6873 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6874 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6875
6876 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6877 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6878 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6879 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6880 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6881 of sections.
6882
6883 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6884 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6885 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6886 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6887 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6888 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6889 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6890
6891 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6892 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6893 to be string literals.
6894
6895 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6896 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6897 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6898 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6899
6900 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6901 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6902 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6903 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6904 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6905 reuse @code{text_section}.
6906
6907 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6908 if the target does not provide them.
6909
6910 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6911 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6912 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6913 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6914 @end defmac
6915
6916 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6917 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6918 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6919 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6920 @end defmac
6921
6922 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6923 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6924 executed functions in the program.
6925 @end defmac
6926
6927 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6928 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6929 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6930 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6931 @end defmac
6932
6933 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6934 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6935 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6936 initialized, writable small data.
6937 @end defmac
6938
6939 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6940 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6941 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6942 data.
6943 @end defmac
6944
6945 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6946 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6947 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6948 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6949 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6950 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6951 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6952 used.
6953 @end defmac
6954
6955 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6956 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6957 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6958 uninitialized, writable small data.
6959 @end defmac
6960
6961 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6962 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6963 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6964 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6965 @end defmac
6966
6967 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6968 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6969 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6970 default is @code{'T'}.
6971 @end defmac
6972
6973 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6974 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6975 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6976 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6977 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6978 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6979 @end defmac
6980
6981 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6982 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6983 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6984 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6985 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6986 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6987 @end defmac
6988
6989 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6990 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6991 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6992 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6993 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6994 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6995 @end defmac
6996
6997 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6998 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6999 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7000 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7001 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7002 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7003 @end defmac
7004
7005 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7006 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7007 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7008 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7009 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7010 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7011 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7012 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7013 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7014 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7015 @end defmac
7016
7017 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7018 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7019 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7020 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7021 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7022 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7023 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7024 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7025 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7026 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7027 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7028 @end defmac
7029
7030 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7031 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7032 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7033 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7034 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7035 @end defmac
7036
7037 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7038 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7039 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7040 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7041 readonly data section is used.
7042
7043 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7044 @end defmac
7045
7046 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7047 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7048 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7049 of its own that you need to create.
7050
7051 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7052 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7053 described below.
7054 @end deftypefn
7055
7056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7057 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7058 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7059 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7060 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7061
7062 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7063 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7064 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7065 in read-only sections even in executables.
7066 @end deftypefn
7067
7068 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7069 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7070 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7071 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7072 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7073 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7074 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7075
7076 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7077 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7078
7079 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7080 @end deftypefn
7081
7082 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7083 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7084 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7085
7086 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7087 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7088 it is unlikely to be called.
7089 @end defmac
7090
7091 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7092 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7093 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7094 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7095 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7096
7097 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7098 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7099 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7100 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7101 @end deftypefn
7102
7103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7104 Return the readonly data section associated with
7105 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7106 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7107 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7108 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7109 otherwise.
7110 @end deftypefn
7111
7112 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7113 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7114 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7115 the string if a different section name should be used.
7116 @end deftypevr
7117
7118 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7119 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7120 @end deftypefn
7121
7122 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7123 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7124 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7125 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7126 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7127 in bits.
7128
7129 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7130 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7131 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7132 @end deftypefn
7133
7134 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7135 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7136 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7137 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7138 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7139 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7140 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7141 returns the @var{id} provided.
7142 @end deftypefn
7143
7144 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7145 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7146 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7147 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7148
7149 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7150 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7151 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7152 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7153 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7154
7155 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7156 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7157 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7158 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7159 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7160 leave it alone.)
7161
7162 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7163 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7164 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7165 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7166 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7167 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7168
7169 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7170 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7171 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7172 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7173 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7174 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7175
7176 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7177 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7178 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7179 before overriding it.
7180 @end deftypefn
7181
7182 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7183 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7184 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7185 may have added.
7186 @end deftypefn
7187
7188 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7189 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7190 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7191 @end deftypefn
7192
7193 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7194 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7195 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7196 @end deftypevr
7197
7198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7199 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7200
7201 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7202 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7203 @end deftypefn
7204
7205 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7206 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7207 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7208 or executable image).
7209
7210 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7211 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7212 currently supported object file formats.
7213 @end deftypefn
7214
7215 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7216 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7217 The default value is false.
7218 @end deftypevr
7219
7220
7221 @node PIC
7222 @section Position Independent Code
7223 @cindex position independent code
7224 @cindex PIC
7225
7226 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7227 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7228 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7229 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7230 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7231 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7232 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7233 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7234 relative addresses.
7235 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7236 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7237
7238 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7239 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7240 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7241 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7242 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7243 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7244 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7245 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7246 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7247 @end defmac
7248
7249 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7250 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7251 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7252 the default is zero. Do not define
7253 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7254 @end defmac
7255
7256 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7257 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7258 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7259 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7260 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7261 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7262 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7263 position independent code.
7264 @end defmac
7265
7266 @node Assembler Format
7267 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7268
7269 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7270 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7271 instructions do.
7272
7273 @menu
7274 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7275 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7276 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7277 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7278 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7279 and termination routines.
7280 * Macros for Initialization::
7281 Specific macros that control the handling of
7282 initialization and termination routines.
7283 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7284 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7285 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7286 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7287 @end menu
7288
7289 @node File Framework
7290 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7291 @cindex assembler format
7292 @cindex output of assembler code
7293
7294 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7295 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7296
7297 @findex default_file_start
7298 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7299 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7300 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7301 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7302 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7303 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7304 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7305 @end deftypefn
7306
7307 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7308 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7309 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7310 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7311 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7312 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7313 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7314 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7315
7316 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7317 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7318 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7319 @end deftypevr
7320
7321 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7322 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7323 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7324 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7325 this to be done. The default is false.
7326 @end deftypevr
7327
7328 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7329 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7330 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7331 @end deftypefn
7332
7333 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7334 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7335 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7336 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7337 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7338 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7339 this function.
7340 @end deftypefun
7341
7342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7343 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7344 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7345 nothing.
7346 @end deftypefn
7347
7348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7349 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7350 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7351 nothing.
7352 @end deftypefn
7353
7354 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7355 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7356 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7357 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7358 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7359 nothing.
7360 @end deftypefn
7361
7362 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7363 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7364 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7365 the end of the line.
7366 @end defmac
7367
7368 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7369 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7370 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7371 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7372 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7373 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7374 @end defmac
7375
7376 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7377 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7378 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7379 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7380 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7381 @end defmac
7382
7383 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7384 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7385 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7386 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7387
7388 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7389 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7390 @end defmac
7391
7392 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7393 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7394
7395 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7396 @end deftypefn
7397
7398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7399 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7400 @end deftypefn
7401
7402 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7403 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7404 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7405 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7406 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7407 of the filename using this macro.
7408 @end defmac
7409
7410 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7411 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7412 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7413 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7414 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7415 this section is associated.
7416 @end deftypefn
7417
7418 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7419 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7420 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7421 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7422 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7423 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7424 (from static destructors).
7425 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7426 @end deftypefn
7427
7428 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7429 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7430 @end deftypefn
7431
7432 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7433 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7434 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7435 @end deftypevr
7436
7437 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7438 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7439 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7440 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7441 This is true on most ELF targets.
7442 @end deftypevr
7443
7444 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7445 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7446 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7447 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7448 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7449
7450 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7451 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7452 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7453 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7454 @end deftypefn
7455
7456 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7457 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7458 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7459 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7460 It can take the following values:
7461
7462 @table @gcctabopt
7463 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7464 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7465
7466 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7467 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7468 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7469 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7470 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7471 various different individual optimization passes.
7472
7473 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7474 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7475 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7476 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7477 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7478 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7479 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7480 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7481 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7482 switches.
7483
7484 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7485 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7486
7487 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7488 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7489 @end table
7490
7491 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7492 supported in the future.
7493
7494 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7495 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7496 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7497 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7498 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7499 hook.
7500 @end deftypefn
7501
7502 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7503 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7504 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7505 hook.
7506 @end deftypevr
7507
7508 @need 2000
7509 @node Data Output
7510 @subsection Output of Data
7511
7512
7513 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7514 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7515 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7516 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7517 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7518 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7519 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7520 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7521 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7522 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7523 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7524 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7525 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7526 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7527
7528 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7529 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7530 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7531 @end deftypevr
7532
7533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7534 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7535 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7536 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7537 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7538 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7539 split the object into smaller parts.
7540
7541 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7542 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7543 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7544 @end deftypefn
7545
7546 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7547 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7548 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7549 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7550 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7551
7552 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7553 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7554 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7555 return @code{true}.
7556 @end deftypefn
7557
7558 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7559 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7560 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7561 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7562 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7563
7564 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7565 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7566 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7567 @end defmac
7568
7569 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7570 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7571 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7572 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7573 @end defmac
7574
7575 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7576 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7577 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7578 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7579 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7580 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7581 pool before the function.
7582 @end defmac
7583
7584 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7585 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7586 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7587 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7588 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7589 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7590 immediately after this call.
7591
7592 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7593 not be defined.
7594 @end defmac
7595
7596 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7597 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7598 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7599 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7600
7601 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7602 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7603 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7604 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7605 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7606 alignment.
7607
7608 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7609 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7610 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7611 Here is how to do this:
7612
7613 @smallexample
7614 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7615 @end smallexample
7616
7617 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7618 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7619 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7620
7621 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7622 @end defmac
7623
7624 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7625 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7626 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7627 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7628 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7629 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7630
7631 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7632 define this macro.
7633 @end defmac
7634
7635 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7636 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7637 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7638 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7639 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7640
7641 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7642 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7643 @end defmac
7644
7645 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7646 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7647 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7648 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7649 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7650 @end deftypevr
7651
7652 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7653 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7654
7655 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7656 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7657 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7658 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7659 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7660 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7661 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7662 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7663 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7664 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7665 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7666 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7667 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7668 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7669 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7670 on the host machine.
7671
7672 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7673 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7674 machine's memory.
7675 @end defmac
7676
7677 @node Uninitialized Data
7678 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7679
7680 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7681 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7682
7683 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7684 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7685 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7686 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7687 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7688 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7689 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7690 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7691 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7692 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7693 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7694 an ordinary undefined external.
7695
7696 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7697 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7698 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7699
7700 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7701 common global variables are output.
7702 @end defmac
7703
7704 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7705 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7706 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7707 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7708 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7709 as the number of bits.
7710 @end defmac
7711
7712 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7713 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7714 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7715 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7716 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7717 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7718 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7719 @end defmac
7720
7721 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7722 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7723 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7724 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7725 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7726
7727 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7728 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7729 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7730 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7731 the name, and a newline.
7732
7733 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7734 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7735 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7736 You do not need to do both.
7737
7738 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7739 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7740 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7741 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7742 common in order to save space in the object file.
7743 @end defmac
7744
7745 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7746 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7747 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7748 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7749 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7750
7751 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7752 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7753 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7754
7755 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7756 static variables are output.
7757 @end defmac
7758
7759 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7760 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7761 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7762 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7763 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7764 as the number of bits.
7765 @end defmac
7766
7767 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7768 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7769 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7770 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7771 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7772 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7773 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7774 @end defmac
7775
7776 @node Label Output
7777 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7778
7779 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7780 This is about outputting labels.
7781
7782 @findex assemble_name
7783 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7784 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7785 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7786 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7787 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7788 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7789 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7790 @end defmac
7791
7792 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7793 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7794 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7795 a function.
7796 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7797 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7798 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7799 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7800
7801 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7802 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7803 @end defmac
7804
7805 @findex assemble_name_raw
7806 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7807 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7808 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7809 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7810 that it is more efficient.
7811 @end defmac
7812
7813 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7814 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7815 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7816 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7817 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7818
7819 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7820 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7821 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7822 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7823 define this macro.
7824 @end defmac
7825
7826 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7827 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7828 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7829 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7830 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7831 provided.
7832 @end defmac
7833
7834 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7835 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7836 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7837 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7838 address.
7839
7840 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7841 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7842 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7843 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7844 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7845 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7846 @end defmac
7847
7848 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7849 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7850 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7851 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7852 @samp{.} is used instead.
7853 @end defmac
7854
7855 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7856 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7857 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7858 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7859 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7860 @end defmac
7861
7862 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7863 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7864 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7865 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7866 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7867
7868 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7869 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7870 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7871 types at all, do not define this macro.
7872 @end defmac
7873
7874 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7875 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7876 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7877 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7878 the default is not to define this macro.
7879
7880 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7881 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7882 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7883 types at all, do not define this macro.
7884 @end defmac
7885
7886 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7887 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7888 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7889 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7890 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7891 you should not count on this.
7892
7893 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7894 definition of this macro is provided.
7895 @end defmac
7896
7897 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7898 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7899 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7900 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7901 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7902 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7903 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7904
7905 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7906 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7907
7908 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7909 of this macro.
7910 @end defmac
7911
7912 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7913 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7914 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7915 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7916 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7917 representing the function.
7918
7919 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7920
7921 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7922 of this macro.
7923 @end defmac
7924
7925 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7926 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7928 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7929 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7930 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7931
7932 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7933 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7934
7935 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7936 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7937 @end defmac
7938
7939 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7940 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7941 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7942 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7943 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7944 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7945 will be an internal label.
7946
7947 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7948 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7949
7950 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7951 @end deftypefn
7952
7953 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7954 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7955 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7956 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7957
7958 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7959 nothing.
7960 @end defmac
7961
7962 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7963 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7964 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7965 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7966 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7967 something about the size of the object.
7968
7969 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7970 nothing.
7971
7972 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7973 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7974 @end defmac
7975
7976 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7977 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7978 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7979 that is, available for reference from other files.
7980
7981 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7982 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7983 @end deftypefn
7984
7985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7986 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7987 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7988 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7989
7990 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7991 @end deftypefn
7992
7993 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7994 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7995 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7996 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7997 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7998 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7999 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8000 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8001
8002 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8003 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8004 macro.
8005 @end defmac
8006
8007 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8008 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8009 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8010 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8011 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8012 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8013 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8014 to make @var{name} weak.
8015 @end defmac
8016
8017 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8018 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8019 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8020 declaration of @code{name}.
8021 @end defmac
8022
8023 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8024 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8025 supports weak symbols.
8026
8027 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8028 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8029 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8030 @end defmac
8031
8032 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8033 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8034
8035 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8036 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8037 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8038 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8039 @end defmac
8040
8041 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8042 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8043 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8044 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8045 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8046 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8047 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8048 @end defmac
8049
8050 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8051 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8052 semantics.
8053
8054 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8055 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8056 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8057 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8058 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8059 be emitted as one-only.
8060 @end defmac
8061
8062 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8063 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8064 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8065 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8066 @end deftypefn
8067
8068 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8069 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8070 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8071 The default is @code{0}.
8072
8073 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8074 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8075 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8076 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8077 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8078 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8079 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8080
8081 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8082 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8083 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8084 table of contents.
8085 @end defmac
8086
8087 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8088 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8089 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8090 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8091 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8092 declaration.
8093
8094 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8095 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8096 @end defmac
8097
8098 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8099 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8100 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8101 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8102 @end deftypefn
8103
8104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8105 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8106 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8107 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8108 @end deftypefn
8109
8110 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8111 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8112 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8113 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8114 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8115 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8116 @end defmac
8117
8118 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8119 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8120 @end deftypefn
8121
8122 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8123 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8124 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8125 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8126 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8127 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8128 @end defmac
8129
8130 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8131 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8132 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8133 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8134 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8135 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8136 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8137 being taken.
8138 @end defmac
8139
8140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8141 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8142 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8143
8144 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8145 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8146 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8147
8148 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8149 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8150 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8151 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8152 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8153
8154 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8155 @end deftypefn
8156
8157 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8158 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8159 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8160 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8161 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8162 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8163 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8164 bundles.
8165
8166 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8167 used.
8168 @end defmac
8169
8170 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8171 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8172 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8173
8174 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8175 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8176 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8177
8178 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8179 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8180 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8181 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8182 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8183 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8184 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8185 @end defmac
8186
8187 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8188 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8189 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8190 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8191 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8192
8193 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8194 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8195 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8196 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8197 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8198 internal static variables in different scopes.
8199
8200 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8201 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8202 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8203 between the name and the number will suffice.
8204
8205 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8206 which is correct for most systems.
8207 @end defmac
8208
8209 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8210 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8211 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8212
8213 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8214 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8215 correct for most systems.
8216 @end defmac
8217
8218 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8219 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8220 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8221 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8222 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8223 the tree nodes are available.
8224
8225 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8226 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8227 correct for most systems.
8228 @end defmac
8229
8230 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8231 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8232 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8233 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8234 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8235 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8236 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8237 @end defmac
8238
8239 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8240 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8241 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8242 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8243 an undefined weak symbol.
8244
8245 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8246 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8247 @end defmac
8248
8249 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8250 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8251 Objective-C methods.
8252
8253 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8254 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8255 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8256 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8257
8258 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8259 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8260 systems define other ways of computing names.
8261
8262 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8263 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8264 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8265 50 characters extra.
8266
8267 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8268 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8269 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8270 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8271
8272 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8273 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8274 @end defmac
8275
8276 @node Initialization
8277 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8278 @cindex initialization routines
8279 @cindex termination routines
8280 @cindex constructors, output of
8281 @cindex destructors, output of
8282
8283 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8284 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8285 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8286 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8287 @code{main} is called.
8288
8289 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8290 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8291 terminates.
8292
8293 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8294 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8295 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8296 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8297
8298 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8299 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8300 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8301
8302 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8303 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8304 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8305 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8306 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8307
8308 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8309 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8310 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8311 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8312 pointer containing zero.
8313
8314 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8315 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8316 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8317 list; destructors in forward order.
8318
8319 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8320 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8321 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8322 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8323 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8324 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8325 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8326 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8327
8328 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8329 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8330 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8331 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8332 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8333
8334 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8335 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8336 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8337 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8338 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8339
8340 @smallexample
8341 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8342 @end smallexample
8343
8344 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8345 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8346 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8347 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8348 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8349
8350 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8351 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8352 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8353 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8354 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8355 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8356
8357 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8358 macro properly.
8359
8360 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8361 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8362 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8363 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8364 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8365 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8366
8367 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8368 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8369 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8370 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8371 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8372 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8373 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8374 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8375 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8376 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8377 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8378 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8379 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8380 the initialization process.
8381
8382 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8383 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8384 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8385 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8386 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8387 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8388 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8389 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8390 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8391 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8392 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8393
8394 @ifinfo
8395 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8396 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8397 @end ifinfo
8398
8399 @node Macros for Initialization
8400 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8401
8402 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8403 and termination functions:
8404
8405 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8406 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8407 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8408 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8409 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8410 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8411 run the initialization functions.
8412 @end defmac
8413
8414 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8415 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8416 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8417 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8418 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8419 @end defmac
8420
8421 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8422 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8423 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8424 @end defmac
8425
8426 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8427 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8428 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8429 @end defmac
8430
8431 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8432 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8433 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8434 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8435 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8436 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8437
8438 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8439 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8440 exception tables embedded in the code.
8441 @end defmac
8442
8443 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8444 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8445 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8446 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8447 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8448 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8449 @end defmac
8450
8451 @defmac INVOKE__main
8452 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8453 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8454 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8455 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8456 @end defmac
8457
8458 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8459 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8460 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8461 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8462 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8463 @end defmac
8464
8465 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8466 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8467 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8468 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8469 @end deftypevr
8470
8471 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8472 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8473 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8474
8475 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8476 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8477 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8478 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8479
8480 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8481 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8482 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8483 is not defined.
8484 @end deftypefn
8485
8486 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8487 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8488 functions rather than initialization functions.
8489 @end deftypefn
8490
8491 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8492 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8493
8494 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8495 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8496 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8497
8498 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8499 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8500
8501 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8502 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8503 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8504 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8505
8506 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8507 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8508 @end defmac
8509
8510 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8511 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8512 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8513 @command{nm}.
8514 @end defmac
8515
8516 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8517 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8518 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8519 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8520 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8521 produces.
8522 @end defmac
8523
8524 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8525 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8526 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8527 termination functions in shared libraries:
8528
8529 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8530 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8531 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8532 @end defmac
8533
8534 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8535 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8536 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8537 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8538 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8539 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8540 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8541 @end defmac
8542
8543 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8544 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8545 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8546 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8547 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8548 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8549 @end defmac
8550
8551 @node Instruction Output
8552 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8553
8554 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8555 This describes assembler instruction output.
8556
8557 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8558 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8559 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8560 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8561 @end defmac
8562
8563 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8564 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8565 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8566 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8567 to registers using alternate names.
8568 @end defmac
8569
8570 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8571 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8572 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8573 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8574 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8575 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8576 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8577 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8578
8579 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8580 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8581 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8582 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8583 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8584 @end defmac
8585
8586 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8587 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8588 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8589
8590 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8591 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8592 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8593 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8594 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8595 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8596 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8597 so that it will not be output twice.
8598
8599 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8600 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8601 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8602 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8603 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8604
8605 @findex recog_data.operand
8606 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8607 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8608
8609 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8610 in the usual way.
8611 @end defmac
8612
8613 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8614 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8615 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8616 they will be output differently.
8617
8618 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8619 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8620 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8621 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8622 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8623 by changing the contents of the vector.
8624
8625 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8626 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8627 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8628 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8629 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8630 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8631
8632 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8633 @end defmac
8634
8635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8636 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8637 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8638 if necessary.
8639
8640 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8641 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8642 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8643 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8644 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8645 by checking the contents of the vector.
8646 @end deftypefn
8647
8648 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8649 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8650 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8651 RTL expression.
8652
8653 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8654 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8655 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8656 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8657 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8658 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8659 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8660
8661 @findex reg_names
8662 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8663 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8664 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8665 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8666
8667 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8668 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8669 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8670 @var{code}.
8671 @end defmac
8672
8673 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8674 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8675 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8676 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8677 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8678 in this way.
8679 @end defmac
8680
8681 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8682 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8683 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8684 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8685
8686 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8687 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8688 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8689 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8690 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8691 Format}.
8692 @end defmac
8693
8694 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8695 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8696 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8697 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8698 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8699 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8700 or whatever.
8701
8702 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8703 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8704 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8705 @end defmac
8706
8707 @findex final_sequence
8708 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8709 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8710 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8711 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8712 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8713 being output.
8714
8715 @findex asm_fprintf
8716 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8717 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8718 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8719 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8720 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8721 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8722 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8723 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8724 files can define these macros differently.
8725 @end defmac
8726
8727 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8728 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8729 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8730 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8731 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8732 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8733 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8734 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8735 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8736 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8737 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8738 @end defmac
8739
8740 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8741 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8742 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8743 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8744 first variant.
8745
8746 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8747 @smallexample
8748 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8749 @end smallexample
8750 @noindent
8751 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8752 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8753 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8754 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8755 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8756 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8757 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8758
8759 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8760 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8761 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8762
8763 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8764 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8765 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8766 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8767 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8768 opcodes or operand order.
8769 @end defmac
8770
8771 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8772 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8773 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8774 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8775 profiling.
8776 @end defmac
8777
8778 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8779 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8780 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8781 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8782 profiling.
8783 @end defmac
8784
8785 @node Dispatch Tables
8786 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8787
8788 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8789 This concerns dispatch tables.
8790
8791 @cindex dispatch table
8792 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8793 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8794 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8795 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8796 definitions of these labels are output using
8797 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8798 way here. For example,
8799
8800 @smallexample
8801 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8802 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8803 @end smallexample
8804
8805 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8806 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8807 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8808 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8809 mode and flags can be read.
8810 @end defmac
8811
8812 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8813 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8814 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8815
8816 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8817 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8818 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8819 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8820 For example,
8821
8822 @smallexample
8823 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8824 @end smallexample
8825 @end defmac
8826
8827 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8828 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8829 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8830 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8831 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8832 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8833
8834 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8835 for the table.
8836
8837 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8838 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8839 @end defmac
8840
8841 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8842 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8843 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8844 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8845 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8846 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8847 of the preceding label.
8848
8849 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8850 the jump-table.
8851 @end defmac
8852
8853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8854 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8855 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8856 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8857 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8858 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8859 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8860 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8861
8862 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8863 @end deftypefn
8864
8865 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8866 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8867 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8868 to be broken up according to function.
8869
8870 The default is that no label is emitted.
8871 @end deftypefn
8872
8873 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8874 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8875 @end deftypefn
8876
8877 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8878 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8879 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8880 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8881 @end deftypefn
8882
8883 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8884 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8885 @end deftypevr
8886
8887 @node Exception Region Output
8888 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8889
8890 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8891
8892 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8893 region.
8894
8895 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8896 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8897 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8898 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8899 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8900
8901 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8902 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8903 @end defmac
8904
8905 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8906 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8907 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8908 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8909 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8910
8911 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8912 also defined.
8913 @end defmac
8914
8915 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8916 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8917 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8918 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8919 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8920 @end defmac
8921
8922 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8923 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8924 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8925 @end defmac
8926
8927 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8928 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8929 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8930 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8931 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8932 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8933 @end defmac
8934
8935 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8936 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8937 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8938 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8939 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8940 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8941 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8942
8943 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8944 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8945 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8946
8947 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8948 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8949 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8950 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8951 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8952 depending on this setting.
8953
8954 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8955 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8956 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8957 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8958 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8959 @end deftypefn
8960
8961 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8962 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8963 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8964 command-line option processing.
8965 @end deftypevr
8966
8967 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8968 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8969 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8970 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8971 @end defmac
8972
8973 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8974 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8975 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8976 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8977 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8978 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8979 @end defmac
8980
8981 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8982 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8983 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8984 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8985 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8986 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8987 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8988 @end defmac
8989
8990 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8991 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8992 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8993 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8994 true otherwise.
8995 @end deftypevr
8996
8997 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8998 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8999 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9000 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9001 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9002 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9003 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9004 @end deftypefn
9005
9006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9007 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9008 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9009 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9010 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9011 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9012 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9013 @end deftypefn
9014
9015 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9016 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9017 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9018 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9019 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9020 @end deftypefn
9021
9022 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9023 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9024 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9025 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9026 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9027 @end deftypevr
9028
9029 @node Alignment Output
9030 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9031
9032 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9033 This describes commands for alignment.
9034
9035 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9036 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9037 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9038
9039 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9040 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9041 define the macro.
9042
9043 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9044 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9045 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9046 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9047 @end defmac
9048
9049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9050 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9051 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9052 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9053 @end deftypefn
9054
9055 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9056 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9057 a @code{BARRIER}.
9058
9059 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9060 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9061 define the macro.
9062 @end defmac
9063
9064 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9065 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9066 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9067 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9068 @end deftypefn
9069
9070 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9071 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9072 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
9073
9074 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9075 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9076 define the macro.
9077
9078 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9079 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9080 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9081 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9082 @end defmac
9083
9084 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9085 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9086 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9087 defined.
9088 @end deftypefn
9089
9090 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9091 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9092 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9093 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9094
9095 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9096 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9097 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9098 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9099 @end defmac
9100
9101 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9102 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9103 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9104 is defined.
9105 @end deftypefn
9106
9107 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9108 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9109 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9110 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9111 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9112 @end defmac
9113
9114 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9115 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9116 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9117 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9118 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9119 section.
9120 @end defmac
9121
9122 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9123 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9124 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9125 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9126 @end defmac
9127
9128 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9129 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9130 for padding, if necessary.
9131 @end defmac
9132
9133 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9134 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9135 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9136 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9137 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9138 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9139 @end defmac
9140
9141 @need 3000
9142 @node Debugging Info
9143 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9144
9145 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9146 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9147
9148 @menu
9149 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9150 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9151 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9152 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9153 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9154 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9155 @end menu
9156
9157 @node All Debuggers
9158 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9159
9160 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9161 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9162
9163 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9164 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9165 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9166 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9167 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9168 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9169 compiler and another for DBX@.
9170
9171 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9172 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9173 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9174 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9175 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9176
9177 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9178 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9179 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9180 @end defmac
9181
9182 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9183 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9184 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9185 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9186 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9187 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9188 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9189 @option{-g} options is used.
9190 @end defmac
9191
9192 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9193 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9194 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9195 @var{offset}.
9196 @end defmac
9197
9198 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9199 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9200 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9201 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9202 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9203 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9204 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9205
9206 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9207 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9208 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9209 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9210 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9211
9212 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9213 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9214 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9215 @end defmac
9216
9217 @node DBX Options
9218 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9219
9220 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9221 These are specific options for DBX output.
9222
9223 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9224 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9225 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9226 @end defmac
9227
9228 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9229 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9230 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9231 @end defmac
9232
9233 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9234 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9235 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9236 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9237 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9238 if there is any occasion to.
9239 @end defmac
9240
9241 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9242 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9243 in the text section.
9244 @end defmac
9245
9246 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9247 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9248 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9249 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9250 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9251 @end defmac
9252
9253 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9254 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9255 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9256 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9257 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9258 information format.
9259 @end defmac
9260
9261 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9262 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9263 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9264 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9265 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9266 @end defmac
9267
9268 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9269 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9270 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9271 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9272 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9273 @end defmac
9274
9275 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9276 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9277 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9278 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9279 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9280 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9281 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9282 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9283 @end defmac
9284
9285 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9286 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9287 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9288 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9289 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9290 if backslash is correct for your system.
9291 @end defmac
9292
9293 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9294 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9295 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9296 variable.
9297 @end defmac
9298
9299 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9300 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9301 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9302 @end defmac
9303
9304 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9305 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9306 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9307 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9308 @end defmac
9309
9310 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9311 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9312 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9313 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9314 @end defmac
9315
9316 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9317 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9318 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9319 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9320 @end defmac
9321
9322 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9323 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9324 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9325 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9326 code.
9327 @end defmac
9328
9329 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9330 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9331 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9332 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9333 an absolute address.
9334 @end defmac
9335
9336 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9337 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9338 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9339 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9340 @end defmac
9341
9342 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9343 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9344 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9345 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9346 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9347 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9348 number for a type number.
9349 @end defmac
9350
9351 @node DBX Hooks
9352 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9353
9354 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9355 These are hooks for DBX format.
9356
9357 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9358 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9359 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9360 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9361 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9362 unique labels in the assembly output.
9363
9364 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9365 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9366 @end defmac
9367
9368 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9369 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9370 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9371 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9372 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9373 @end defmac
9374
9375 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9376 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9377 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9378 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9379 @end defmac
9380
9381 @node File Names and DBX
9382 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9383
9384 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9385 This describes file names in DBX format.
9386
9387 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9388 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9389 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9390 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9391 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9392
9393 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9394 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9395
9396 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9397 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9398 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9399 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9400 @end defmac
9401
9402 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9403 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9404 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9405 the beginning of the file.
9406 @end defmac
9407
9408 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9409 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9410 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9411 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9412 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9413 @end defmac
9414
9415 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9416 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9417 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9418 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9419
9420 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9421 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9422 @end defmac
9423
9424 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9425 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9426 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9427 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9428 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9429 @end defmac
9430
9431 @need 2000
9432 @node SDB and DWARF
9433 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9434
9435 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9436 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9437
9438 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9439 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9440 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9441 @end defmac
9442
9443 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9444 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9445 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9446
9447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9448 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9449 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9450 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9451 @end deftypefn
9452
9453 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9454 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9455 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9456 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9457 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9458 @end defmac
9459
9460 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9461 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9462 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9463 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9464 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9465 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9466 @end defmac
9467
9468 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9469 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9470 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9471 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9472 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9473
9474 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9475 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9476
9477 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9478 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9479 @end deftypefn
9480
9481 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9482 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9483 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9484 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9485 @end defmac
9486
9487 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9488 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9489 @end deftypevr
9490
9491 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9492 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9493 @end deftypevr
9494
9495 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9496 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9497 @end deftypevr
9498
9499 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9500 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9501 @end deftypevr
9502
9503 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9504 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9505 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9506 @end defmac
9507
9508 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9509 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9510 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9511 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9512 @end defmac
9513
9514 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9515 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9516 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9517 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9518 @end defmac
9519
9520 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9521 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9522 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9523 @end defmac
9524
9525 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9526 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9527 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9528 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9529 is referenced by a function.
9530 @end defmac
9531
9532 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9533 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9534 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9535 @end deftypefn
9536
9537 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9538 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9539 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9540 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9541 not define them yourself.
9542 @end defmac
9543
9544 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9545 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9546 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9547 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9548 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9549 required.
9550 @end defmac
9551
9552 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9553 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9554 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9555 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9556 it.
9557 @end defmac
9558
9559 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9560 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9561 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9562 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9563 @end defmac
9564
9565 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9566 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9567 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9568 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9569 @end defmac
9570
9571 @need 2000
9572 @node VMS Debug
9573 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9574
9575 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9576 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9577
9578 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9579 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9580 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9581 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9582 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9583 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9584 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9585 @end defmac
9586
9587 @node Floating Point
9588 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9589 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9590 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9591
9592 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9593 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9594 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9595 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9596 doing the compilation.
9597
9598 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9599 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9600 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9601 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9602 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9603 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9604 target floating point formats are identical.
9605
9606 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9607 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9608 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9609 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9610
9611 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9612 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9613 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9614 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9615 quantity.
9616 @end defmac
9617
9618 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9619 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9620 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9621 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9622 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9623 @end deftypefn
9624
9625 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9626 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9627 @end deftypefn
9628
9629 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9630 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9631 @end deftypefn
9632
9633 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9634 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9635 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9636 @end deftypefn
9637
9638 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9639 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9640 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9641 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9642 defined by the C language for both.
9643 @end deftypefn
9644
9645 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9646 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9647 @end deftypefn
9648
9649 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9650 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9651 @end deftypefn
9652
9653 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9654 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9655 @end deftypefn
9656
9657 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9658 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9659 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9660 variable).
9661
9662 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9663 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9664 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9665
9666 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9667 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9668 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9669 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9670 @end deftypefn
9671
9672 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9673 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9674 @end deftypefn
9675
9676 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9677 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9678 @end deftypefn
9679
9680 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9681 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9682 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9683 integral, it is truncated.
9684 @end deftypefn
9685
9686 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9687 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9688 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9689 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9690 @end deftypefn
9691
9692 @node Mode Switching
9693 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9694 @cindex mode switching
9695 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9696
9697 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9698 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9699 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9700
9701 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9702 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9703 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9704 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9705 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9706 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9707 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9708
9709 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9710 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9711 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9712 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9713 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9714 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9715 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9716 are optional.
9717 @end defmac
9718
9719 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9720 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9721 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9722 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9723 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9724 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9725 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9726 entity in question.
9727 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9728 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9729 switch is needed / supplied.
9730 @end defmac
9731
9732 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9733 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9734 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9735 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9736 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9737 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9738 @end defmac
9739
9740 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9741 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9742 this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9743 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9744 different from the incoming mode).
9745 @end defmac
9746
9747 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9748 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9749 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9750 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9751 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9752 @end defmac
9753
9754 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9755 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9756 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9757 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9758 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9759 @end defmac
9760
9761 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9762 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9763 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9764 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9765 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9766 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9767 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9768 @end defmac
9769
9770 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9771 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9772 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9773 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9774 @end defmac
9775
9776 @node Target Attributes
9777 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9778 @cindex target attributes
9779 @cindex machine attributes
9780 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9781
9782 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9783 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9784 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9785
9786 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9787 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9788 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9789 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9790 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9791 take.
9792 @end deftypevr
9793
9794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9795 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9796 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9797 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9798 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9799 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9800 @end deftypefn
9801
9802 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9803 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9804 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9805 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9806 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9807 supposed always to be compatible.
9808 @end deftypefn
9809
9810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9811 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9812 the newly defined @var{type}.
9813 @end deftypefn
9814
9815 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9816 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9817 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9818 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9819 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9820 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9821 merging.
9822 @end deftypefn
9823
9824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9825 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9826 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9827 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9828 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9829 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9830 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9831 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9832
9833 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9834 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9835 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9836 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9837 will then define a function called
9838 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9839 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9840 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9841 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9842 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9843 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9844 @end deftypefn
9845
9846 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9847 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9848 @end deftypefn
9849
9850 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9851 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9852 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9853 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9854 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9855 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9856 on this implementation detail.
9857 @end defmac
9858
9859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9860 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9861 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9862 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9863 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9864 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9865 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9866 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9867 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9868 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9869 needed.
9870 @end deftypefn
9871
9872 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9873 @cindex inlining
9874 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9875 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9876 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9877 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9878 @end deftypefn
9879
9880 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9881 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9882 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9883 options for the current function that might be different than the
9884 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9885 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9886
9887 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9888 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9889 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9890 @end deftypefn
9891
9892 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9893 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9894 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9895 options.
9896 @xref{Option file format}.
9897 @end deftypefn
9898
9899 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9900 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9901 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9902 function specific options.
9903 @end deftypefn
9904
9905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9906 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9907 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9908 function specific options.
9909 @end deftypefn
9910
9911 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9912 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9913 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9914 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9915 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9916 @end deftypefn
9917
9918 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9919 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9920 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9921 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9922 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9923
9924 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9925 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9926
9927 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9928 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9929 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9930 @end deftypefn
9931
9932 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
9933 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
9934 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
9935 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
9936 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
9937 different target machines.
9938 @end deftypefn
9939
9940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9941 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9942 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9943 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9944 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9945 @end deftypefn
9946
9947 @node Emulated TLS
9948 @section Emulating TLS
9949 @cindex Emulated TLS
9950
9951 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9952 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9953 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9954 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9955 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9956 layer.
9957
9958 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9959 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9960 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9961 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9962
9963 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9964 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9965 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9966 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9967 @end deftypevr
9968
9969 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9970 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9971 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9972 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9973 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9974 registration function to be used.
9975 @end deftypevr
9976
9977 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9978 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9979 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9980 any section.
9981 @end deftypevr
9982
9983 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9984 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9985 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9986 section.
9987 @end deftypevr
9988
9989 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9990 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9991 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9992 @end deftypevr
9993
9994 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9995 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9996 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9997 @end deftypevr
9998
9999 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10000 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10001 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10002 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10003 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10004 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10005 @end deftypefn
10006
10007 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10008 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10009 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10010 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10011 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10012 @end deftypefn
10013
10014 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10015 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10016 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10017 single objects. The default is false.
10018 @end deftypevr
10019
10020 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10021 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10022 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10023 @end deftypevr
10024
10025 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10026 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10027 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10028
10029 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10030 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10031 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10032 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10033
10034 @smallexample
10035 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10036 unsigned int d;
10037
10038 d = cp0count + 3;
10039 @end smallexample
10040
10041 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10042 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10043 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10044
10045 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10046 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10047 later in the function.
10048
10049 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10050 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10051 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10052
10053 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10054 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10055
10056 @node PCH Target
10057 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10058 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10059
10060 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10061 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10062 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10063 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10064 @end deftypefn
10065
10066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10067 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10068 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10069 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10070 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10071
10072 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10073 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10074 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10075 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10076
10077 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10078 suitable for most targets.
10079 @end deftypefn
10080
10081 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10082 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10083 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10084 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10085 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10086 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10087 @end deftypefn
10088
10089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10090 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10091 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10092 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10093 to do anything here.
10094 @end deftypefn
10095
10096 @node C++ ABI
10097 @section C++ ABI parameters
10098 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10099
10100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10101 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10102 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10103 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10104 @end deftypefn
10105
10106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10107 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10108 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10109 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10110 @end deftypefn
10111
10112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10113 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10114 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10115 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10116 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10117 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10118 @end deftypefn
10119
10120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10121 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10122 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10123 @end deftypefn
10124
10125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10126 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10127 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10128 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10129 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10130 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10131 backend's targeted operating system.
10132 @end deftypefn
10133
10134 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10135 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10136 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10137 @code{false}.
10138 @end deftypefn
10139
10140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10141 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10142 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10143 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10144 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10145 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10146 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10147 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10148 @end deftypefn
10149
10150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10151 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10152 @end deftypefn
10153
10154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10155 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10156 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10157 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10158 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10159 unit will not be COMDAT.
10160 @end deftypefn
10161
10162 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10163 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10164 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10165 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10166 @end deftypefn
10167
10168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10169 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10170 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10171 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10172 @end deftypefn
10173
10174 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10175 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10176 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10177 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10178 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10179 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10180 @end deftypefn
10181
10182 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10183 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10184 @end deftypefn
10185
10186 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10187 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10188 @end deftypefn
10189
10190 @node Named Address Spaces
10191 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10192 @cindex named address spaces
10193
10194 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10195 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10196 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10197 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10198 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10199 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10200 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10201 @code{const} type attributes.
10202
10203 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10204 pointers to the generic address space.
10205
10206 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10207 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10208 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10209 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10210 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10211 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10212 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10213 always 32 bits).
10214
10215 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10216 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10217 address space.
10218
10219 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10220 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10221 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10222 named address space #1:
10223 @smallexample
10224 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10225 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10226 @end smallexample
10227
10228 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10229 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10230 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10231 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10232 generic address space only.
10233 @end deftypefn
10234
10235 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10236 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10237 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10238 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10239 generic address space only.
10240 @end deftypefn
10241
10242 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10243 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10244 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10245 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10246 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10247 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10248 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10249 target hooks for the given address space.
10250 @end deftypefn
10251
10252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10253 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10254 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10255 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10256 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10257 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10258 explicit named address space support.
10259 @end deftypefn
10260
10261 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10262 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10263 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10264 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10265 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10266 @end deftypefn
10267
10268 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10269 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10270 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10271 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10272 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10273 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10274 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10275 @end deftypefn
10276
10277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10278 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10279 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10280 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10281 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10282 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10283 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10284 @end deftypefn
10285
10286 @node Misc
10287 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10288 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10289
10290 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10291 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10292
10293 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10294 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10295 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10296 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10297 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10298 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10299 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10300 @end defmac
10301
10302 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10303 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10304 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10305 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10306 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10307 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10308 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10309 @end defmac
10310
10311 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10312 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10313 elements of a jump-table should have.
10314 @end defmac
10315
10316 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10317 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10318 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10319 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10320 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10321 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10322 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10323 flags can be updated.
10324 @end defmac
10325
10326 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10327 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10328 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10329 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10330 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10331 is in effect.
10332 @end defmac
10333
10334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10335 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10336 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10337 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10338 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10339 @end deftypefn
10340
10341 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10342 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10343 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10344 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10345 @end defmac
10346
10347 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10348 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10349 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10350 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10351 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10352 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10353 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10354 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10355
10356 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10357 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10358 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10359 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10360 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10361
10362 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10363 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10364 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10365 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10366 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10367
10368 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10369 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10370 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10371 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10372 @end defmac
10373
10374 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10375 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10376 extends.
10377 @end defmac
10378
10379 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10380 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10381 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10382 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10383 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10384 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10385 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10386 @end deftypefn
10387
10388 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10389 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10390 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10391 @end defmac
10392
10393 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10394 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10395 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10396 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10397 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10398 at run-time.
10399 @end defmac
10400
10401 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10402 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10403 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10404 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10405 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10406 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10407 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10408 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10409 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10410 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10411 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10412
10413 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10414 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10415 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10416
10417 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10418 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10419 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10420 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10421 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10422
10423 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10424 @end defmac
10425
10426 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10427 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10428 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10429 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10430 @xref{shift patterns}.
10431
10432 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10433 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10434 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10435 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10436 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10437 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10438
10439 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10440 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10441 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10442
10443 The default implementation of this function returns
10444 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10445 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10446 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10447 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10448 by overriding it.
10449 @end deftypefn
10450
10451 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10452 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10453 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10454 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10455 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10456
10457 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10458
10459 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10460 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10461 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10462 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10463 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10464 such cases may improve things.
10465 @end defmac
10466
10467 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10468 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10469 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10470 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10471 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10472 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10473 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10474 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10475 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10476 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10477 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10478
10479 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10480 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10481 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10482 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10483
10484 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10485 describe two related properties. If you define
10486 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10487 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10488 extension.
10489
10490 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10491 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10492 @code{mode}.
10493 @end deftypefn
10494
10495 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10496 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10497 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10498 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10499 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10500 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10501
10502 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10503 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10504 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10505 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10506 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10507 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10508 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10509 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10510 the compiler.
10511
10512 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10513 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10514 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10515 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10516 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10517 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10518 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10519 expression
10520
10521 @smallexample
10522 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10523 @end smallexample
10524
10525 @noindent
10526 can be converted to
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10530 @end smallexample
10531
10532 @noindent
10533 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10534 tested into the sign bit.
10535
10536 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10537 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10538 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10539 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10540 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10541 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10542
10543 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10544 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10545 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10546 to be used:
10547
10548 @itemize @bullet
10549 @item
10550 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10551 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10552 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10553 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10554 combine the normalization with other operations.
10555
10556 @item
10557 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10558 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10559 other machines.
10560
10561 @item
10562 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10563 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10564 others.
10565
10566 @item
10567 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10568 @end itemize
10569
10570 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10571 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10572 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10573 those cases, e.g., one matching
10574
10575 @smallexample
10576 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10577 @end smallexample
10578
10579 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10580 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10581 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10582 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10583 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10584 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10585 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10586 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10587
10588 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10589 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10590 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10591 @end defmac
10592
10593 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10594 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10595 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10596 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10597 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10598 this macro.
10599 @end defmac
10600
10601 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10602 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10603 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10604 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10605 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10606 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10607 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10608 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10609 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10610 given mode.
10611 @end defmac
10612
10613 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10614 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10615 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10616 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10617 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10618 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10619 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10620 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10621 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10622 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10623 this value.
10624
10625 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10626 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10627
10628 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10629 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10630 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10631 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10632
10633 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10634 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10635 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10636 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10637 breaking the API@.
10638 @end defmac
10639
10640 @defmac Pmode
10641 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10642 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10643 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10644 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10645 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10646
10647 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10648 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10649 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10650 to @code{Pmode}.
10651 @end defmac
10652
10653 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10654 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10655 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10656 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10657 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10658 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10659 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10660 @end defmac
10661
10662 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10663 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10664 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10665 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10666 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10667 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10668
10669 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10670 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10671 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10672 @end defmac
10673
10674 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10675 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10676
10677 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10678 @end deftypefn
10679
10680 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10681 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10682 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10683 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10684 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10685 @end defmac
10686
10687 @findex #pragma
10688 @findex pragma
10689 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10690 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10691 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10692 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10693 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10694 setup required for the pragmas.
10695
10696 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10697 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10698 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10699
10700 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10701 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10702
10703 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10704 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10705 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10706 @end defmac
10707
10708 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10709 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10710
10711 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10712 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10713 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10714 pragma of the form
10715
10716 @smallexample
10717 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10718 @end smallexample
10719
10720 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10721 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10722 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10723 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10724 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10725 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10726 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10727 arguments of pragmas registered with
10728 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10729 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10730
10731 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10732 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10733 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10734 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10735 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10736 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10737 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10738 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10739 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10740 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10741 how to build this object file.
10742 @end deftypefun
10743
10744 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10745 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10746 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10747 @end defmac
10748
10749 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10750 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10751 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10752 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10753 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10754 @end defmac
10755
10756 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10757 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10758 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10759 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10760 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10761 @end defmac
10762
10763 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10764 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10765 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10766 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10767 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10768 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10769 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10770 you should define this macro.
10771
10772 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10773 @end defmac
10774
10775 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10776 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10777 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10778 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10779 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10780 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10781 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10782 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10783 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10784 slot of @var{insn}.
10785
10786 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10787 @end defmac
10788
10789 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10790 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10791 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10792 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10793 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10794 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10795
10796 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10797 @end defmac
10798
10799 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10800 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10801 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10802 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10803 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10804 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10805 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10806 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10807 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10808 @end deftypefn
10809
10810 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10811 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10812 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10813 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10814 separate math library.
10815
10816 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10817 @end defmac
10818
10819 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10820 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10821 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10822
10823 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10824 is wrong.
10825 @end defmac
10826
10827 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10828 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10829 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10830 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10831 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10832 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10833 for cross-profiling.
10834 @end defmac
10835
10836 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10837
10838 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10839 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10840 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10841 1 if it does use cc0.
10842 @end defmac
10843
10844 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10845 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10846 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10847 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10848 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10849 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10850 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10851 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10852 @end defmac
10853
10854 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10855 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10856 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10857 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10858 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10859 @end defmac
10860
10861 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10862 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10863 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10864 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10865 about the currently processed blocks.
10866 @end defmac
10867
10868 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10869 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10870 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10871 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10872 to by @var{ce_info}.
10873 @end defmac
10874
10875 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10876 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10877 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10878 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10879 to by @var{ce_info}.
10880 @end defmac
10881
10882 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10883 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10884 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10885 to by @var{ce_info}.
10886 @end defmac
10887
10888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10889 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10890 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10891 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10892
10893 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10894 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10895 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10896 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10897
10898 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10899 definition is null.
10900 @end deftypefn
10901
10902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10903 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10904 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10905 necessary setup.
10906
10907 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10908 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10909 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10910 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10911
10912 To create a built-in function, call the function
10913 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10914 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10915 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10916 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10917 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10918 @end deftypefn
10919
10920 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10921 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10922 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10923 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10924 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10925 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10926 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10927 @code{error_mark_node}.
10928 @end deftypefn
10929
10930 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10931
10932 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10933 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10934 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10935 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10936 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10937 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10938 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10939 built-in function.
10940 @end deftypefn
10941
10942 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10943 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10944 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10945 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10946 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10947 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10948 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10949 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10950 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10951 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10952 @end deftypefn
10953
10954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10955 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10956 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10957 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10958 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10959 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10960 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10961 @end deftypefn
10962
10963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10964 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
10965 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
10966 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
10967 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
10968 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
10969 the two function decls that will be compared.
10970 @end deftypefn
10971
10972 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
10973 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
10974 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
10975 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
10976 identical versions.
10977 @end deftypefn
10978
10979 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
10980 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
10981 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
10982 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
10983 body must be generated.
10984 @end deftypefn
10985
10986 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10987
10988 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10989 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10990 could not be applied.
10991
10992 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10993 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10994 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10995 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10996 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10997 @end deftypefn
10998
10999 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx @var{insn})
11000 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11001 @end deftypefn
11002
11003 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
11004
11005 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
11006 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
11007 @var{branch2} is possible.
11008
11009 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
11010 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
11011 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
11012 @end defmac
11013
11014 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const_rtx @var{follower}, const_rtx @var{followee})
11015 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11016 @end deftypefn
11017
11018 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11019 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11020 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11021 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11022 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11023 @end deftypefn
11024
11025 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11026
11027 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11028 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11029 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11030 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11031 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11032 that had its initial value copied by using
11033 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11034 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11035 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11036 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11037 @code{MEM}.
11038 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11039 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11040 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11041 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11042 register in question will not be clobbered.
11043 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11044 allocation.
11045 @end deftypefn
11046
11047 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11048 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11049 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11050 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11051 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11052 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11053 passed along.
11054 @end deftypefn
11055
11056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11057 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11058 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11059 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11060 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11061 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11062 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11063 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11064 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11065 The default hook function does nothing.
11066
11067 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11068 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11069 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11070 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11071 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11072 outside of any function scope.
11073 @end deftypefn
11074
11075 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11076 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11077 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11078 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11079 @end defmac
11080
11081 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11082 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11083 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11084 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11085 executable files.
11086 @end defmac
11087
11088 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11089 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11090 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11091 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11092 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11093 lists.
11094 @end defmac
11095
11096 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11097 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11098 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11099 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11100 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11101 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11102 defined as this expression:
11103
11104 @smallexample
11105 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11106 build_tree_list
11107 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11108 NULL))
11109 @end smallexample
11110 @end defmac
11111
11112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11113 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11114 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11115 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11116 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11117
11118 @smallexample
11119 static bool
11120 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11121 @{
11122 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11123 @}
11124 @end smallexample
11125 @end deftypefn
11126
11127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11128 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11129 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11130 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11131 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11132 to inter-block scheduling.
11133 @end deftypefn
11134
11135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11136 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11137 registers
11138 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11139 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11140 that all target registers in the class returned by
11141 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11142 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11143 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11144 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11145 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11146 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11147 @end deftypefn
11148
11149 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11150 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11151 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11152 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11153 @end deftypefn
11154
11155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11156 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11157 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11158 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11159 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11160 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11161 number of memory accesses.
11162 @end deftypefn
11163
11164 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11165 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11166 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11167 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11168 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11169 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11170 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11171 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11172 @end defmac
11173
11174 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11175 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11176 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11177 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11178 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11179 @end deftypefn
11180
11181 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11182 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11183 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11184 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11185 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11186 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11187 @end deftypefn
11188
11189 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11190 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11191 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11192 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11193 that are different from @option{-I}.
11194 @end deftypefn
11195
11196 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11197 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11198 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11199 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11200 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11201 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11202 @end defmac
11203
11204 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11205 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11206 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11207 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11208 @end defmac
11209
11210 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11211 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11212 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11213 @end defmac
11214
11215 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11216 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11217 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11218 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11219 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11220 @end defmac
11221
11222 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11223 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11224 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11225 @end defmac
11226
11227 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11228 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11229 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11230 and scanf formatter settings.
11231 @end defmac
11232
11233 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11234 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11235 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11236 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11237 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11238 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11239 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11240 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11241 @end deftypevr
11242
11243 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11244 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11245 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11246 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11247 @end deftypefn
11248
11249 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11250 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11251 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11252 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11253 @end deftypefn
11254
11255 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11256 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11257 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11258 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11259 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11260 @end deftypefn
11261
11262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11263 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11264 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11265 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11266 the front end.
11267 @end deftypefn
11268
11269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11270 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11271 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11272 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11273 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11274 @end deftypefn
11275
11276 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11277 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11278 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11279 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11280 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11281 @end deftypefn
11282
11283 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11284 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11285 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11286 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11287 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11288 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11289 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11290 @end deftypefn
11291
11292 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11293 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11294 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11295 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11296 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11297 conversion rules.
11298 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11299 @end deftypefn
11300
11301 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11302 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11303 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11304 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11305 @end defmac
11306
11307 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11308 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11309 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11310 @end defmac
11311
11312 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11313 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11314 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11315 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11316 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11317 @end defmac
11318
11319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11320 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11321 necessary.
11322 @end deftypefn
11323
11324 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11325 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11326 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11327 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11328 is needed.
11329 @end deftypefn
11330
11331 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11332 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11333 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11334 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11335 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11336 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11337 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11338 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11339 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11340 @end deftypefn
11341
11342 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11343 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11344 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11345 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11346 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11347 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11348 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11349 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11350 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11351 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11352 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11353 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11354 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11355 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11356 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11357 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11358 @end deftypevr
11359
11360 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11361 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11362 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11363 supported by the target.
11364 @end deftypefn
11365
11366 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11367 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11368 memory model bits are allowed.
11369 @end deftypefn
11370
11371 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11372 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11373 @end deftypevr